2bd5e058b7
Bring The following revisions from the gcc43 branch[1]: 118360, 118361, 118363, 118576, 119820, 123906, 125246, and 125721. They all have in common that the were merged long ago into Apple's gcc and should help improve the general quality of the compiler and make it easier to bring new features from Apple's gcc42. For details please review the additions to the files: gcc/ChangeLog.gcc43 gcc/cp/ChangeLog.gcc43 (new, adds previous revisions) Reference: [1] http://gcc.gnu.org/viewcvs/gcc/trunk/?pathrev=126700 Obtained from: gcc pre4.3 (GPLv2) branch MFC after: 3 weeks
9523 lines
291 KiB
C
9523 lines
291 KiB
C
/* Convert tree expression to rtl instructions, for GNU compiler.
|
||
Copyright (C) 1988, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
|
||
2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation,
|
||
Inc.
|
||
|
||
This file is part of GCC.
|
||
|
||
GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
|
||
the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
|
||
Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
|
||
version.
|
||
|
||
GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
|
||
WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
|
||
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License
|
||
for more details.
|
||
|
||
You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
|
||
along with GCC; see the file COPYING. If not, write to the Free
|
||
Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
|
||
02110-1301, USA. */
|
||
|
||
#include "config.h"
|
||
#include "system.h"
|
||
#include "coretypes.h"
|
||
#include "tm.h"
|
||
#include "machmode.h"
|
||
#include "real.h"
|
||
#include "rtl.h"
|
||
#include "tree.h"
|
||
#include "flags.h"
|
||
#include "regs.h"
|
||
#include "hard-reg-set.h"
|
||
#include "except.h"
|
||
#include "function.h"
|
||
#include "insn-config.h"
|
||
#include "insn-attr.h"
|
||
/* Include expr.h after insn-config.h so we get HAVE_conditional_move. */
|
||
#include "expr.h"
|
||
#include "optabs.h"
|
||
#include "libfuncs.h"
|
||
#include "recog.h"
|
||
#include "reload.h"
|
||
#include "output.h"
|
||
#include "typeclass.h"
|
||
#include "toplev.h"
|
||
#include "ggc.h"
|
||
#include "langhooks.h"
|
||
#include "intl.h"
|
||
#include "tm_p.h"
|
||
#include "tree-iterator.h"
|
||
#include "tree-pass.h"
|
||
#include "tree-flow.h"
|
||
#include "target.h"
|
||
#include "timevar.h"
|
||
|
||
/* Decide whether a function's arguments should be processed
|
||
from first to last or from last to first.
|
||
|
||
They should if the stack and args grow in opposite directions, but
|
||
only if we have push insns. */
|
||
|
||
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
|
||
|
||
#ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
|
||
#if defined (STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD) != defined (ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD)
|
||
#define PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED /* If it's last to first. */
|
||
#endif
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
#ifndef STACK_PUSH_CODE
|
||
#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
#define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_DEC
|
||
#else
|
||
#define STACK_PUSH_CODE PRE_INC
|
||
#endif
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* If this is nonzero, we do not bother generating VOLATILE
|
||
around volatile memory references, and we are willing to
|
||
output indirect addresses. If cse is to follow, we reject
|
||
indirect addresses so a useful potential cse is generated;
|
||
if it is used only once, instruction combination will produce
|
||
the same indirect address eventually. */
|
||
int cse_not_expected;
|
||
|
||
/* This structure is used by move_by_pieces to describe the move to
|
||
be performed. */
|
||
struct move_by_pieces
|
||
{
|
||
rtx to;
|
||
rtx to_addr;
|
||
int autinc_to;
|
||
int explicit_inc_to;
|
||
rtx from;
|
||
rtx from_addr;
|
||
int autinc_from;
|
||
int explicit_inc_from;
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
||
int reverse;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
/* This structure is used by store_by_pieces to describe the clear to
|
||
be performed. */
|
||
|
||
struct store_by_pieces
|
||
{
|
||
rtx to;
|
||
rtx to_addr;
|
||
int autinc_to;
|
||
int explicit_inc_to;
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
||
rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
|
||
void *constfundata;
|
||
int reverse;
|
||
};
|
||
|
||
static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
|
||
unsigned int,
|
||
unsigned int);
|
||
static void move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
|
||
struct move_by_pieces *);
|
||
static bool block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void);
|
||
static bool emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
|
||
static rtx emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx, rtx, rtx, bool);
|
||
static tree emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int);
|
||
static void emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx, rtx, rtx, unsigned);
|
||
static rtx clear_by_pieces_1 (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode);
|
||
static void clear_by_pieces (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
|
||
static void store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces *, unsigned int);
|
||
static void store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode,
|
||
struct store_by_pieces *);
|
||
static rtx clear_storage_via_libcall (rtx, rtx, bool);
|
||
static tree clear_storage_libcall_fn (int);
|
||
static rtx compress_float_constant (rtx, rtx);
|
||
static rtx get_subtarget (rtx);
|
||
static void store_constructor_field (rtx, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT,
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
|
||
tree, tree, int, int);
|
||
static void store_constructor (tree, rtx, int, HOST_WIDE_INT);
|
||
static rtx store_field (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode,
|
||
tree, tree, int);
|
||
|
||
static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT highest_pow2_factor_for_target (tree, tree);
|
||
|
||
static int is_aligning_offset (tree, tree);
|
||
static void expand_operands (tree, tree, rtx, rtx*, rtx*,
|
||
enum expand_modifier);
|
||
static rtx reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx, rtx, tree);
|
||
static rtx do_store_flag (tree, rtx, enum machine_mode, int);
|
||
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
|
||
static void emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode, rtx, tree);
|
||
#endif
|
||
static void do_tablejump (rtx, enum machine_mode, rtx, rtx, rtx);
|
||
static rtx const_vector_from_tree (tree);
|
||
static void write_complex_part (rtx, rtx, bool);
|
||
|
||
/* Record for each mode whether we can move a register directly to or
|
||
from an object of that mode in memory. If we can't, we won't try
|
||
to use that mode directly when accessing a field of that mode. */
|
||
|
||
static char direct_load[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
static char direct_store[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
|
||
/* Record for each mode whether we can float-extend from memory. */
|
||
|
||
static bool float_extend_from_mem[NUM_MACHINE_MODES][NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
|
||
/* This macro is used to determine whether move_by_pieces should be called
|
||
to perform a structure copy. */
|
||
#ifndef MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
|
||
#define MOVE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
|
||
(move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
|
||
< (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO)
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* This macro is used to determine whether clear_by_pieces should be
|
||
called to clear storage. */
|
||
#ifndef CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P
|
||
#define CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
|
||
(move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
|
||
< (unsigned int) CLEAR_RATIO)
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* This macro is used to determine whether store_by_pieces should be
|
||
called to "memset" storage with byte values other than zero, or
|
||
to "memcpy" storage when the source is a constant string. */
|
||
#ifndef STORE_BY_PIECES_P
|
||
#define STORE_BY_PIECES_P(SIZE, ALIGN) \
|
||
(move_by_pieces_ninsns (SIZE, ALIGN, STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1) \
|
||
< (unsigned int) MOVE_RATIO)
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* This array records the insn_code of insns to perform block moves. */
|
||
enum insn_code movmem_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
|
||
/* This array records the insn_code of insns to perform block sets. */
|
||
enum insn_code setmem_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
|
||
/* These arrays record the insn_code of three different kinds of insns
|
||
to perform block compares. */
|
||
enum insn_code cmpstr_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code cmpstrn_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code cmpmem_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
|
||
/* Synchronization primitives. */
|
||
enum insn_code sync_add_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_sub_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_ior_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_and_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_xor_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_nand_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_old_add_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_old_sub_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_old_ior_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_old_and_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_old_xor_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_old_nand_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_new_add_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_new_sub_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_new_ior_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_new_and_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_new_xor_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_new_nand_optab[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_compare_and_swap[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_compare_and_swap_cc[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_lock_test_and_set[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
enum insn_code sync_lock_release[NUM_MACHINE_MODES];
|
||
|
||
/* SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS is nonzero if unaligned accesses are very slow. */
|
||
|
||
#ifndef SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS
|
||
#define SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS(MODE, ALIGN) STRICT_ALIGNMENT
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* This is run once per compilation to set up which modes can be used
|
||
directly in memory and to initialize the block move optab. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
init_expr_once (void)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx insn, pat;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
int num_clobbers;
|
||
rtx mem, mem1;
|
||
rtx reg;
|
||
|
||
/* Try indexing by frame ptr and try by stack ptr.
|
||
It is known that on the Convex the stack ptr isn't a valid index.
|
||
With luck, one or the other is valid on any machine. */
|
||
mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
|
||
mem1 = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, frame_pointer_rtx);
|
||
|
||
/* A scratch register we can modify in-place below to avoid
|
||
useless RTL allocations. */
|
||
reg = gen_rtx_REG (VOIDmode, -1);
|
||
|
||
insn = rtx_alloc (INSN);
|
||
pat = gen_rtx_SET (0, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX);
|
||
PATTERN (insn) = pat;
|
||
|
||
for (mode = VOIDmode; (int) mode < NUM_MACHINE_MODES;
|
||
mode = (enum machine_mode) ((int) mode + 1))
|
||
{
|
||
int regno;
|
||
|
||
direct_load[(int) mode] = direct_store[(int) mode] = 0;
|
||
PUT_MODE (mem, mode);
|
||
PUT_MODE (mem1, mode);
|
||
PUT_MODE (reg, mode);
|
||
|
||
/* See if there is some register that can be used in this mode and
|
||
directly loaded or stored from memory. */
|
||
|
||
if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode)
|
||
for (regno = 0; regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
&& (direct_load[(int) mode] == 0 || direct_store[(int) mode] == 0);
|
||
regno++)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (regno, mode))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
REGNO (reg) = regno;
|
||
|
||
SET_SRC (pat) = mem;
|
||
SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
|
||
if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
|
||
direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
|
||
|
||
SET_SRC (pat) = mem1;
|
||
SET_DEST (pat) = reg;
|
||
if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
|
||
direct_load[(int) mode] = 1;
|
||
|
||
SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
|
||
SET_DEST (pat) = mem;
|
||
if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
|
||
direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
|
||
|
||
SET_SRC (pat) = reg;
|
||
SET_DEST (pat) = mem1;
|
||
if (recog (pat, insn, &num_clobbers) >= 0)
|
||
direct_store[(int) mode] = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
mem = gen_rtx_MEM (VOIDmode, gen_rtx_raw_REG (Pmode, 10000));
|
||
|
||
for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); mode != VOIDmode;
|
||
mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode srcmode;
|
||
for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_FLOAT); srcmode != mode;
|
||
srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
|
||
{
|
||
enum insn_code ic;
|
||
|
||
ic = can_extend_p (mode, srcmode, 0);
|
||
if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
PUT_MODE (mem, srcmode);
|
||
|
||
if ((*insn_data[ic].operand[1].predicate) (mem, srcmode))
|
||
float_extend_from_mem[mode][srcmode] = true;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This is run at the start of compiling a function. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
init_expr (void)
|
||
{
|
||
cfun->expr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct expr_status));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Copy data from FROM to TO, where the machine modes are not the same.
|
||
Both modes may be integer, or both may be floating.
|
||
UNSIGNEDP should be nonzero if FROM is an unsigned type.
|
||
This causes zero-extension instead of sign-extension. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
convert_move (rtx to, rtx from, int unsignedp)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode to_mode = GET_MODE (to);
|
||
enum machine_mode from_mode = GET_MODE (from);
|
||
int to_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode);
|
||
int from_real = SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode);
|
||
enum insn_code code;
|
||
rtx libcall;
|
||
|
||
/* rtx code for making an equivalent value. */
|
||
enum rtx_code equiv_code = (unsignedp < 0 ? UNKNOWN
|
||
: (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND));
|
||
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (to_real == from_real);
|
||
gcc_assert (to_mode != BLKmode);
|
||
gcc_assert (from_mode != BLKmode);
|
||
|
||
/* If the source and destination are already the same, then there's
|
||
nothing to do. */
|
||
if (to == from)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
|
||
the required extension, strip it. We don't handle such SUBREGs as
|
||
TO here. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (from)
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (from)))
|
||
>= GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode))
|
||
&& SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (from) == unsignedp)
|
||
from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, from), from_mode = to_mode;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (to) != SUBREG || !SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (to));
|
||
|
||
if (to_mode == from_mode
|
||
|| (from_mode == VOIDmode && CONSTANT_P (from)))
|
||
{
|
||
emit_move_insn (to, from);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode) || VECTOR_MODE_P (from_mode))
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode));
|
||
|
||
if (VECTOR_MODE_P (to_mode))
|
||
from = simplify_gen_subreg (to_mode, from, GET_MODE (from), 0);
|
||
else
|
||
to = simplify_gen_subreg (from_mode, to, GET_MODE (to), 0);
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (to, from);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (to) == CONCAT && GET_CODE (from) == CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
convert_move (XEXP (to, 0), XEXP (from, 0), unsignedp);
|
||
convert_move (XEXP (to, 1), XEXP (from, 1), unsignedp);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (to_real)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx value, insns;
|
||
convert_optab tab;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert ((GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode)
|
||
!= GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
|
||
|| (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode)
|
||
!= DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (to_mode)));
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) == GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
|
||
/* Conversion between decimal float and binary float, same size. */
|
||
tab = DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (from_mode) ? trunc_optab : sext_optab;
|
||
else if (GET_MODE_PRECISION (from_mode) < GET_MODE_PRECISION (to_mode))
|
||
tab = sext_optab;
|
||
else
|
||
tab = trunc_optab;
|
||
|
||
/* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
|
||
|
||
code = tab->handlers[to_mode][from_mode].insn_code;
|
||
if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_unop_insn (code, to, from,
|
||
tab == sext_optab ? FLOAT_EXTEND : FLOAT_TRUNCATE);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise use a libcall. */
|
||
libcall = tab->handlers[to_mode][from_mode].libfunc;
|
||
|
||
/* Is this conversion implemented yet? */
|
||
gcc_assert (libcall);
|
||
|
||
start_sequence ();
|
||
value = emit_library_call_value (libcall, NULL_RTX, LCT_CONST, to_mode,
|
||
1, from, from_mode);
|
||
insns = get_insns ();
|
||
end_sequence ();
|
||
emit_libcall_block (insns, to, value,
|
||
tab == trunc_optab ? gen_rtx_FLOAT_TRUNCATE (to_mode,
|
||
from)
|
||
: gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (to_mode, from));
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Handle pointer conversion. */ /* SPEE 900220. */
|
||
/* Targets are expected to provide conversion insns between PxImode and
|
||
xImode for all MODE_PARTIAL_INT modes they use, but no others. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (to_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode full_mode
|
||
= smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode), MODE_INT);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (trunc_optab->handlers[to_mode][full_mode].insn_code
|
||
!= CODE_FOR_nothing);
|
||
|
||
if (full_mode != from_mode)
|
||
from = convert_to_mode (full_mode, from, unsignedp);
|
||
emit_unop_insn (trunc_optab->handlers[to_mode][full_mode].insn_code,
|
||
to, from, UNKNOWN);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (from_mode) == MODE_PARTIAL_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new_from;
|
||
enum machine_mode full_mode
|
||
= smallest_mode_for_size (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode), MODE_INT);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (sext_optab->handlers[full_mode][from_mode].insn_code
|
||
!= CODE_FOR_nothing);
|
||
|
||
if (to_mode == full_mode)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_unop_insn (sext_optab->handlers[full_mode][from_mode].insn_code,
|
||
to, from, UNKNOWN);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
new_from = gen_reg_rtx (full_mode);
|
||
emit_unop_insn (sext_optab->handlers[full_mode][from_mode].insn_code,
|
||
new_from, from, UNKNOWN);
|
||
|
||
/* else proceed to integer conversions below. */
|
||
from_mode = full_mode;
|
||
from = new_from;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now both modes are integers. */
|
||
|
||
/* Handle expanding beyond a word. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
|
||
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx insns;
|
||
rtx lowpart;
|
||
rtx fill_value;
|
||
rtx lowfrom;
|
||
int i;
|
||
enum machine_mode lowpart_mode;
|
||
int nwords = CEIL (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode), UNITS_PER_WORD);
|
||
|
||
/* Try converting directly if the insn is supported. */
|
||
if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
|
||
!= CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If FROM is a SUBREG, put it into a register. Do this
|
||
so that we always generate the same set of insns for
|
||
better cse'ing; if an intermediate assignment occurred,
|
||
we won't be doing the operation directly on the SUBREG. */
|
||
if (optimize > 0 && GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG)
|
||
from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
|
||
emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
/* Next, try converting via full word. */
|
||
else if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD
|
||
&& ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, word_mode, unsignedp))
|
||
!= CODE_FOR_nothing))
|
||
{
|
||
if (REG_P (to))
|
||
{
|
||
if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
|
||
from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
|
||
emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, to));
|
||
}
|
||
convert_move (gen_lowpart (word_mode, to), from, unsignedp);
|
||
emit_unop_insn (code, to,
|
||
gen_lowpart (word_mode, to), equiv_code);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* No special multiword conversion insn; do it by hand. */
|
||
start_sequence ();
|
||
|
||
/* Since we will turn this into a no conflict block, we must ensure
|
||
that the source does not overlap the target. */
|
||
|
||
if (reg_overlap_mentioned_p (to, from))
|
||
from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
|
||
|
||
/* Get a copy of FROM widened to a word, if necessary. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) < BITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
lowpart_mode = word_mode;
|
||
else
|
||
lowpart_mode = from_mode;
|
||
|
||
lowfrom = convert_to_mode (lowpart_mode, from, unsignedp);
|
||
|
||
lowpart = gen_lowpart (lowpart_mode, to);
|
||
emit_move_insn (lowpart, lowfrom);
|
||
|
||
/* Compute the value to put in each remaining word. */
|
||
if (unsignedp)
|
||
fill_value = const0_rtx;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_slt
|
||
if (HAVE_slt
|
||
&& insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_slt].operand[0].mode == word_mode
|
||
&& STORE_FLAG_VALUE == -1)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_cmp_insn (lowfrom, const0_rtx, NE, NULL_RTX,
|
||
lowpart_mode, 0);
|
||
fill_value = gen_reg_rtx (word_mode);
|
||
emit_insn (gen_slt (fill_value));
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
#endif
|
||
{
|
||
fill_value
|
||
= expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, lowpart_mode, lowfrom,
|
||
size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (lowpart_mode) - 1),
|
||
NULL_RTX, 0);
|
||
fill_value = convert_to_mode (word_mode, fill_value, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Fill the remaining words. */
|
||
for (i = GET_MODE_SIZE (lowpart_mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD; i < nwords; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
int index = (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN ? nwords - i - 1 : i);
|
||
rtx subword = operand_subword (to, index, 1, to_mode);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (subword);
|
||
|
||
if (fill_value != subword)
|
||
emit_move_insn (subword, fill_value);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
insns = get_insns ();
|
||
end_sequence ();
|
||
|
||
emit_no_conflict_block (insns, to, from, NULL_RTX,
|
||
gen_rtx_fmt_e (equiv_code, to_mode, copy_rtx (from)));
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Truncating multi-word to a word or less. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode) > BITS_PER_WORD
|
||
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) <= BITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
{
|
||
if (!((MEM_P (from)
|
||
&& ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
|
||
&& direct_load[(int) to_mode]
|
||
&& ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
|
||
|| REG_P (from)
|
||
|| GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
|
||
from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
|
||
convert_move (to, gen_lowpart (word_mode, from), 0);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now follow all the conversions between integers
|
||
no more than a word long. */
|
||
|
||
/* For truncation, usually we can just refer to FROM in a narrower mode. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)
|
||
&& TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
|
||
GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode)))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!((MEM_P (from)
|
||
&& ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (from)
|
||
&& direct_load[(int) to_mode]
|
||
&& ! mode_dependent_address_p (XEXP (from, 0)))
|
||
|| REG_P (from)
|
||
|| GET_CODE (from) == SUBREG))
|
||
from = force_reg (from_mode, from);
|
||
if (REG_P (from) && REGNO (from) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
&& ! HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (from), to_mode))
|
||
from = copy_to_reg (from);
|
||
emit_move_insn (to, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Handle extension. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Convert directly if that works. */
|
||
if ((code = can_extend_p (to_mode, from_mode, unsignedp))
|
||
!= CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_unop_insn (code, to, from, equiv_code);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode intermediate;
|
||
rtx tmp;
|
||
tree shift_amount;
|
||
|
||
/* Search for a mode to convert via. */
|
||
for (intermediate = from_mode; intermediate != VOIDmode;
|
||
intermediate = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (intermediate))
|
||
if (((can_extend_p (to_mode, intermediate, unsignedp)
|
||
!= CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
|| (GET_MODE_SIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (intermediate)
|
||
&& TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode),
|
||
GET_MODE_BITSIZE (intermediate))))
|
||
&& (can_extend_p (intermediate, from_mode, unsignedp)
|
||
!= CODE_FOR_nothing))
|
||
{
|
||
convert_move (to, convert_to_mode (intermediate, from,
|
||
unsignedp), unsignedp);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* No suitable intermediate mode.
|
||
Generate what we need with shifts. */
|
||
shift_amount = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
|
||
GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode)
|
||
- GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode));
|
||
from = gen_lowpart (to_mode, force_reg (from_mode, from));
|
||
tmp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, from, shift_amount,
|
||
to, unsignedp);
|
||
tmp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, to_mode, tmp, shift_amount,
|
||
to, unsignedp);
|
||
if (tmp != to)
|
||
emit_move_insn (to, tmp);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Support special truncate insns for certain modes. */
|
||
if (trunc_optab->handlers[to_mode][from_mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_unop_insn (trunc_optab->handlers[to_mode][from_mode].insn_code,
|
||
to, from, UNKNOWN);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Handle truncation of volatile memrefs, and so on;
|
||
the things that couldn't be truncated directly,
|
||
and for which there was no special instruction.
|
||
|
||
??? Code above formerly short-circuited this, for most integer
|
||
mode pairs, with a force_reg in from_mode followed by a recursive
|
||
call to this routine. Appears always to have been wrong. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (to_mode) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (from_mode))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx temp = force_reg (to_mode, gen_lowpart (to_mode, from));
|
||
emit_move_insn (to, temp);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Mode combination is not recognized. */
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return an rtx for a value that would result
|
||
from converting X to mode MODE.
|
||
Both X and MODE may be floating, or both integer.
|
||
UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
|
||
This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
|
||
or by copying to a new temporary with conversion. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
convert_to_mode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
|
||
{
|
||
return convert_modes (mode, VOIDmode, x, unsignedp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return an rtx for a value that would result
|
||
from converting X from mode OLDMODE to mode MODE.
|
||
Both modes may be floating, or both integer.
|
||
UNSIGNEDP is nonzero if X is an unsigned value.
|
||
|
||
This can be done by referring to a part of X in place
|
||
or by copying to a new temporary with conversion.
|
||
|
||
You can give VOIDmode for OLDMODE, if you are sure X has a nonvoid mode. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
convert_modes (enum machine_mode mode, enum machine_mode oldmode, rtx x, int unsignedp)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
|
||
/* If FROM is a SUBREG that indicates that we have already done at least
|
||
the required extension, strip it. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (x)
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (x))) >= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)
|
||
&& SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (x) == unsignedp)
|
||
x = gen_lowpart (mode, x);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE (x) != VOIDmode)
|
||
oldmode = GET_MODE (x);
|
||
|
||
if (mode == oldmode)
|
||
return x;
|
||
|
||
/* There is one case that we must handle specially: If we are converting
|
||
a CONST_INT into a mode whose size is twice HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT and
|
||
we are to interpret the constant as unsigned, gen_lowpart will do
|
||
the wrong if the constant appears negative. What we want to do is
|
||
make the high-order word of the constant zero, not all ones. */
|
||
|
||
if (unsignedp && GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && INTVAL (x) < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
|
||
|
||
if (oldmode != VOIDmode
|
||
&& HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode))
|
||
{
|
||
int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode);
|
||
|
||
/* We need to zero extend VAL. */
|
||
val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return immed_double_const (val, (HOST_WIDE_INT) 0, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We can do this with a gen_lowpart if both desired and current modes
|
||
are integer, and this is either a constant integer, a register, or a
|
||
non-volatile MEM. Except for the constant case where MODE is no
|
||
wider than HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT, we must be narrowing the operand. */
|
||
|
||
if ((GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
|| (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (oldmode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_DOUBLE
|
||
|| (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode)
|
||
&& ((MEM_P (x) && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (x)
|
||
&& direct_load[(int) mode])
|
||
|| (REG_P (x)
|
||
&& (! HARD_REGISTER_P (x)
|
||
|| HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (REGNO (x), mode))
|
||
&& TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode),
|
||
GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (x)))))))))
|
||
{
|
||
/* ?? If we don't know OLDMODE, we have to assume here that
|
||
X does not need sign- or zero-extension. This may not be
|
||
the case, but it's the best we can do. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == CONST_INT && oldmode != VOIDmode
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) > GET_MODE_SIZE (oldmode))
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (x);
|
||
int width = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode);
|
||
|
||
/* We must sign or zero-extend in this case. Start by
|
||
zero-extending, then sign extend if we need to. */
|
||
val &= ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << width) - 1;
|
||
if (! unsignedp
|
||
&& (val & ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << (width - 1))))
|
||
val |= (HOST_WIDE_INT) (-1) << width;
|
||
|
||
return gen_int_mode (val, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return gen_lowpart (mode, x);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Converting from integer constant into mode is always equivalent to an
|
||
subreg operation. */
|
||
if (VECTOR_MODE_P (mode) && GET_MODE (x) == VOIDmode)
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (oldmode));
|
||
return simplify_gen_subreg (mode, x, oldmode, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
temp = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
||
convert_move (temp, x, unsignedp);
|
||
return temp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* STORE_MAX_PIECES is the number of bytes at a time that we can
|
||
store efficiently. Due to internal GCC limitations, this is
|
||
MOVE_MAX_PIECES limited by the number of bytes GCC can represent
|
||
for an immediate constant. */
|
||
|
||
#define STORE_MAX_PIECES MIN (MOVE_MAX_PIECES, 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
|
||
|
||
/* Determine whether the LEN bytes can be moved by using several move
|
||
instructions. Return nonzero if a call to move_by_pieces should
|
||
succeed. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
can_move_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
|
||
unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
return MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate several move instructions to copy LEN bytes from block FROM to
|
||
block TO. (These are MEM rtx's with BLKmode).
|
||
|
||
If PUSH_ROUNDING is defined and TO is NULL, emit_single_push_insn is
|
||
used to push FROM to the stack.
|
||
|
||
ALIGN is maximum stack alignment we can assume.
|
||
|
||
If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
|
||
mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
|
||
stpcpy. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
move_by_pieces (rtx to, rtx from, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
|
||
unsigned int align, int endp)
|
||
{
|
||
struct move_by_pieces data;
|
||
rtx to_addr, from_addr = XEXP (from, 0);
|
||
unsigned int max_size = MOVE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
|
||
enum insn_code icode;
|
||
|
||
align = MIN (to ? MEM_ALIGN (to) : align, MEM_ALIGN (from));
|
||
|
||
data.offset = 0;
|
||
data.from_addr = from_addr;
|
||
if (to)
|
||
{
|
||
to_addr = XEXP (to, 0);
|
||
data.to = to;
|
||
data.autinc_to
|
||
= (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
|
||
|| GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
|
||
data.reverse
|
||
= (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
to_addr = NULL_RTX;
|
||
data.to = NULL_RTX;
|
||
data.autinc_to = 1;
|
||
#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
data.reverse = 1;
|
||
#else
|
||
data.reverse = 0;
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
data.to_addr = to_addr;
|
||
data.from = from;
|
||
data.autinc_from
|
||
= (GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (from_addr) == PRE_DEC
|
||
|| GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_INC
|
||
|| GET_CODE (from_addr) == POST_DEC);
|
||
|
||
data.explicit_inc_from = 0;
|
||
data.explicit_inc_to = 0;
|
||
if (data.reverse) data.offset = len;
|
||
data.len = len;
|
||
|
||
/* If copying requires more than two move insns,
|
||
copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
|
||
and use post-increment if available. */
|
||
if (!(data.autinc_from && data.autinc_to)
|
||
&& move_by_pieces_ninsns (len, align, max_size) > 2)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Find the mode of the largest move... */
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
|
||
mode = tmode;
|
||
|
||
if (USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_from)
|
||
{
|
||
data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (from_addr, len));
|
||
data.autinc_from = 1;
|
||
data.explicit_inc_from = -1;
|
||
}
|
||
if (USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.autinc_from)
|
||
{
|
||
data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (from_addr);
|
||
data.autinc_from = 1;
|
||
data.explicit_inc_from = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
if (!data.autinc_from && CONSTANT_P (from_addr))
|
||
data.from_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (from_addr);
|
||
if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
|
||
{
|
||
data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (to_addr, len));
|
||
data.autinc_to = 1;
|
||
data.explicit_inc_to = -1;
|
||
}
|
||
if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data.reverse && ! data.autinc_to)
|
||
{
|
||
data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
|
||
data.autinc_to = 1;
|
||
data.explicit_inc_to = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
if (!data.autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
|
||
data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
tmode = mode_for_size (MOVE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
|
||
if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
|
||
align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode xmode;
|
||
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode;
|
||
xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > MOVE_MAX_PIECES
|
||
|| SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* First move what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
|
||
successively smaller modes. */
|
||
|
||
while (max_size > 1)
|
||
{
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
|
||
mode = tmode;
|
||
|
||
if (mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
|
||
if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
|
||
move_by_pieces_1 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, &data);
|
||
|
||
max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The code above should have handled everything. */
|
||
gcc_assert (!data.len);
|
||
|
||
if (endp)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx to1;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
|
||
if (data.autinc_to)
|
||
{
|
||
if (endp == 2)
|
||
{
|
||
if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
|
||
else
|
||
data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (data.to_addr,
|
||
-1));
|
||
}
|
||
to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
|
||
data.offset);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (endp == 2)
|
||
--data.offset;
|
||
to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
|
||
}
|
||
return to1;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return data.to;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return number of insns required to move L bytes by pieces.
|
||
ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
|
||
move_by_pieces_ninsns (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l, unsigned int align,
|
||
unsigned int max_size)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT n_insns = 0;
|
||
enum machine_mode tmode;
|
||
|
||
tmode = mode_for_size (MOVE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
|
||
if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
|
||
align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode tmode, xmode;
|
||
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode;
|
||
xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > MOVE_MAX_PIECES
|
||
|| SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
while (max_size > 1)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
|
||
enum insn_code icode;
|
||
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
|
||
mode = tmode;
|
||
|
||
if (mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
|
||
if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
|
||
n_insns += l / GET_MODE_SIZE (mode), l %= GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
|
||
max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (!l);
|
||
return n_insns;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Subroutine of move_by_pieces. Move as many bytes as appropriate
|
||
with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
|
||
to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
move_by_pieces_1 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
|
||
struct move_by_pieces *data)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
rtx to1 = NULL_RTX, from1;
|
||
|
||
while (data->len >= size)
|
||
{
|
||
if (data->reverse)
|
||
data->offset -= size;
|
||
|
||
if (data->to)
|
||
{
|
||
if (data->autinc_to)
|
||
to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
|
||
data->offset);
|
||
else
|
||
to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (data->autinc_from)
|
||
from1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->from, mode, data->from_addr,
|
||
data->offset);
|
||
else
|
||
from1 = adjust_address (data->from, mode, data->offset);
|
||
|
||
if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
|
||
GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
|
||
if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from < 0)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr,
|
||
GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT)size)));
|
||
|
||
if (data->to)
|
||
emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, from1));
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
|
||
emit_single_push_insn (mode, from1, NULL);
|
||
#else
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
#endif
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
|
||
if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_from > 0)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->from_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
|
||
|
||
if (! data->reverse)
|
||
data->offset += size;
|
||
|
||
data->len -= size;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Emit code to move a block Y to a block X. This may be done with
|
||
string-move instructions, with multiple scalar move instructions,
|
||
or with a library call.
|
||
|
||
Both X and Y must be MEM rtx's (perhaps inside VOLATILE) with mode BLKmode.
|
||
SIZE is an rtx that says how long they are.
|
||
ALIGN is the maximum alignment we can assume they have.
|
||
METHOD describes what kind of copy this is, and what mechanisms may be used.
|
||
|
||
Return the address of the new block, if memcpy is called and returns it,
|
||
0 otherwise. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
emit_block_move (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
|
||
{
|
||
bool may_use_call;
|
||
rtx retval = 0;
|
||
unsigned int align;
|
||
|
||
switch (method)
|
||
{
|
||
case BLOCK_OP_NORMAL:
|
||
case BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL:
|
||
may_use_call = true;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM:
|
||
may_use_call = block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm ();
|
||
|
||
/* Make inhibit_defer_pop nonzero around the library call
|
||
to force it to pop the arguments right away. */
|
||
NO_DEFER_POP;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL:
|
||
may_use_call = false;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
align = MIN (MEM_ALIGN (x), MEM_ALIGN (y));
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
|
||
gcc_assert (MEM_P (y));
|
||
gcc_assert (size);
|
||
|
||
/* Make sure we've got BLKmode addresses; store_one_arg can decide that
|
||
block copy is more efficient for other large modes, e.g. DCmode. */
|
||
x = adjust_address (x, BLKmode, 0);
|
||
y = adjust_address (y, BLKmode, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Set MEM_SIZE as appropriate for this block copy. The main place this
|
||
can be incorrect is coming from __builtin_memcpy. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
if (INTVAL (size) == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
x = shallow_copy_rtx (x);
|
||
y = shallow_copy_rtx (y);
|
||
set_mem_size (x, size);
|
||
set_mem_size (y, size);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT && MOVE_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
|
||
move_by_pieces (x, y, INTVAL (size), align, 0);
|
||
else if (emit_block_move_via_movmem (x, y, size, align))
|
||
;
|
||
else if (may_use_call)
|
||
retval = emit_block_move_via_libcall (x, y, size,
|
||
method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
|
||
else
|
||
emit_block_move_via_loop (x, y, size, align);
|
||
|
||
if (method == BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM)
|
||
OK_DEFER_POP;
|
||
|
||
return retval;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Returns true if calling the
|
||
block move libcall will not clobber any parameters which may have
|
||
already been placed on the stack. */
|
||
|
||
static bool
|
||
block_move_libcall_safe_for_call_parm (void)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If arguments are pushed on the stack, then they're safe. */
|
||
if (PUSH_ARGS)
|
||
return true;
|
||
|
||
/* If registers go on the stack anyway, any argument is sure to clobber
|
||
an outgoing argument. */
|
||
#if defined (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE) && defined (OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE)
|
||
{
|
||
tree fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
|
||
(void) fn;
|
||
if (REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (fn) != 0)
|
||
return false;
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* If any argument goes in memory, then it might clobber an outgoing
|
||
argument. */
|
||
{
|
||
CUMULATIVE_ARGS args_so_far;
|
||
tree fn, arg;
|
||
|
||
fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (false);
|
||
INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (args_so_far, TREE_TYPE (fn), NULL_RTX, 0, 3);
|
||
|
||
arg = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (fn));
|
||
for ( ; arg != void_list_node ; arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_VALUE (arg));
|
||
rtx tmp = FUNCTION_ARG (args_so_far, mode, NULL_TREE, 1);
|
||
if (!tmp || !REG_P (tmp))
|
||
return false;
|
||
if (targetm.calls.arg_partial_bytes (&args_so_far, mode, NULL, 1))
|
||
return false;
|
||
FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (args_so_far, mode, NULL_TREE, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
return true;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a movmem pattern;
|
||
return true if successful. */
|
||
|
||
static bool
|
||
emit_block_move_via_movmem (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size, unsigned int align)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
int save_volatile_ok = volatile_ok;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
|
||
/* Since this is a move insn, we don't care about volatility. */
|
||
volatile_ok = 1;
|
||
|
||
/* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
|
||
including more than one in the machine description unless
|
||
the more limited one has some advantage. */
|
||
|
||
for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
|
||
mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
enum insn_code code = movmem_optab[(int) mode];
|
||
insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
|
||
|
||
if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
|
||
/* We don't need MODE to be narrower than BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT
|
||
here because if SIZE is less than the mode mask, as it is
|
||
returned by the macro, it will definitely be less than the
|
||
actual mode mask. */
|
||
&& ((GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
|
||
<= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
|
||
|| GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
&& ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
|
||
|| (*pred) (x, BLKmode))
|
||
&& ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate) == 0
|
||
|| (*pred) (y, BLKmode))
|
||
&& ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[3].predicate) == 0
|
||
|| (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx op2;
|
||
rtx last = get_last_insn ();
|
||
rtx pat;
|
||
|
||
op2 = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
|
||
pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate;
|
||
if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (op2, mode))
|
||
op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op2);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? When called via emit_block_move_for_call, it'd be
|
||
nice if there were some way to inform the backend, so
|
||
that it doesn't fail the expansion because it thinks
|
||
emitting the libcall would be more efficient. */
|
||
|
||
pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (x, y, op2, opalign);
|
||
if (pat)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_insn (pat);
|
||
volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
|
||
return true;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
delete_insns_since (last);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
volatile_ok = save_volatile_ok;
|
||
return false;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Expand a call to memcpy.
|
||
Return the return value from memcpy, 0 otherwise. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
emit_block_move_via_libcall (rtx dst, rtx src, rtx size, bool tailcall)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx dst_addr, src_addr;
|
||
tree call_expr, arg_list, fn, src_tree, dst_tree, size_tree;
|
||
enum machine_mode size_mode;
|
||
rtx retval;
|
||
|
||
/* Emit code to copy the addresses of DST and SRC and SIZE into new
|
||
pseudos. We can then place those new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and
|
||
use them later. */
|
||
|
||
dst_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (dst, 0));
|
||
src_addr = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (src, 0));
|
||
|
||
dst_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, dst_addr);
|
||
src_addr = convert_memory_address (ptr_mode, src_addr);
|
||
|
||
dst_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, dst_addr);
|
||
src_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, src_addr);
|
||
|
||
size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
|
||
|
||
size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
|
||
size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
|
||
|
||
/* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
|
||
memcpy in this context. This could be a user call to memcpy and
|
||
the user may wish to examine the return value from memcpy. For
|
||
targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
|
||
for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
|
||
|
||
size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
|
||
|
||
fn = emit_block_move_libcall_fn (true);
|
||
arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, size_tree, NULL_TREE);
|
||
arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, src_tree, arg_list);
|
||
arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, dst_tree, arg_list);
|
||
|
||
/* Now we have to build up the CALL_EXPR itself. */
|
||
call_expr = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fn)), fn);
|
||
call_expr = build3 (CALL_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fn)),
|
||
call_expr, arg_list, NULL_TREE);
|
||
CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
|
||
|
||
retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
|
||
|
||
return retval;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_block_move_via_libcall. Create the tree node
|
||
for the function we use for block copies. The first time FOR_CALL
|
||
is true, we call assemble_external. */
|
||
|
||
static GTY(()) tree block_move_fn;
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
init_block_move_fn (const char *asmspec)
|
||
{
|
||
if (!block_move_fn)
|
||
{
|
||
tree args, fn;
|
||
|
||
fn = get_identifier ("memcpy");
|
||
args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
|
||
const_ptr_type_node, sizetype,
|
||
NULL_TREE);
|
||
|
||
fn = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
|
||
DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
|
||
TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
|
||
DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
|
||
TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
|
||
DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
|
||
DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
|
||
|
||
block_move_fn = fn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (asmspec)
|
||
set_user_assembler_name (block_move_fn, asmspec);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static tree
|
||
emit_block_move_libcall_fn (int for_call)
|
||
{
|
||
static bool emitted_extern;
|
||
|
||
if (!block_move_fn)
|
||
init_block_move_fn (NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
|
||
{
|
||
emitted_extern = true;
|
||
make_decl_rtl (block_move_fn);
|
||
assemble_external (block_move_fn);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return block_move_fn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_block_move. Copy the data via an explicit
|
||
loop. This is used only when libcalls are forbidden. */
|
||
/* ??? It'd be nice to copy in hunks larger than QImode. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
emit_block_move_via_loop (rtx x, rtx y, rtx size,
|
||
unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx cmp_label, top_label, iter, x_addr, y_addr, tmp;
|
||
enum machine_mode iter_mode;
|
||
|
||
iter_mode = GET_MODE (size);
|
||
if (iter_mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
iter_mode = word_mode;
|
||
|
||
top_label = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
cmp_label = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
iter = gen_reg_rtx (iter_mode);
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (iter, const0_rtx);
|
||
|
||
x_addr = force_operand (XEXP (x, 0), NULL_RTX);
|
||
y_addr = force_operand (XEXP (y, 0), NULL_RTX);
|
||
do_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
||
|
||
emit_jump (cmp_label);
|
||
emit_label (top_label);
|
||
|
||
tmp = convert_modes (Pmode, iter_mode, iter, true);
|
||
x_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, x_addr, tmp);
|
||
y_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, y_addr, tmp);
|
||
x = change_address (x, QImode, x_addr);
|
||
y = change_address (y, QImode, y_addr);
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (x, y);
|
||
|
||
tmp = expand_simple_binop (iter_mode, PLUS, iter, const1_rtx, iter,
|
||
true, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
if (tmp != iter)
|
||
emit_move_insn (iter, tmp);
|
||
|
||
emit_label (cmp_label);
|
||
|
||
emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (iter, size, LT, NULL_RTX, iter_mode,
|
||
true, top_label);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Copy all or part of a value X into registers starting at REGNO.
|
||
The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
move_block_to_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs, enum machine_mode mode)
|
||
{
|
||
int i;
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
|
||
rtx pat;
|
||
rtx last;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
if (nregs == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
|
||
x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
|
||
|
||
/* See if the machine can do this with a load multiple insn. */
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_load_multiple
|
||
if (HAVE_load_multiple)
|
||
{
|
||
last = get_last_insn ();
|
||
pat = gen_load_multiple (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno), x,
|
||
GEN_INT (nregs));
|
||
if (pat)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_insn (pat);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
delete_insns_since (last);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
|
||
emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i),
|
||
operand_subword_force (x, i, mode));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Copy all or part of a BLKmode value X out of registers starting at REGNO.
|
||
The number of registers to be filled is NREGS. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
move_block_from_reg (int regno, rtx x, int nregs)
|
||
{
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
if (nregs == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* See if the machine can do this with a store multiple insn. */
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_store_multiple
|
||
if (HAVE_store_multiple)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx last = get_last_insn ();
|
||
rtx pat = gen_store_multiple (x, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno),
|
||
GEN_INT (nregs));
|
||
if (pat)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_insn (pat);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
delete_insns_since (last);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx tem = operand_subword (x, i, 1, BLKmode);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (tem);
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (tem, gen_rtx_REG (word_mode, regno + i));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a PARALLEL rtx for a new non-consecutive group of registers from
|
||
ORIG, where ORIG is a non-consecutive group of registers represented by
|
||
a PARALLEL. The clone is identical to the original except in that the
|
||
original set of registers is replaced by a new set of pseudo registers.
|
||
The new set has the same modes as the original set. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
gen_group_rtx (rtx orig)
|
||
{
|
||
int i, length;
|
||
rtx *tmps;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (orig) == PARALLEL);
|
||
|
||
length = XVECLEN (orig, 0);
|
||
tmps = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * length);
|
||
|
||
/* Skip a NULL entry in first slot. */
|
||
i = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1;
|
||
|
||
if (i)
|
||
tmps[0] = 0;
|
||
|
||
for (; i < length; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 0));
|
||
rtx offset = XEXP (XVECEXP (orig, 0, i), 1);
|
||
|
||
tmps[i] = gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode, gen_reg_rtx (mode), offset);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (orig), gen_rtvec_v (length, tmps));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_group_load. Arguments as for emit_group_load,
|
||
except that values are placed in TMPS[i], and must later be moved
|
||
into corresponding XEXP (XVECEXP (DST, 0, i), 0) element. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
emit_group_load_1 (rtx *tmps, rtx dst, rtx orig_src, tree type, int ssize)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx src;
|
||
int start, i;
|
||
enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_src);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL);
|
||
|
||
if (m != VOIDmode
|
||
&& !SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
|
||
&& !MEM_P (orig_src)
|
||
&& GET_CODE (orig_src) != CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_src));
|
||
if (imode == BLKmode)
|
||
src = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_src), ssize, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
src = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
|
||
if (imode != BLKmode)
|
||
src = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_src), src);
|
||
emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
|
||
/* ...and back again. */
|
||
if (imode != BLKmode)
|
||
src = gen_lowpart (imode, src);
|
||
emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
|
||
both on the stack and in registers. */
|
||
if (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, 0), 0))
|
||
start = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
start = 1;
|
||
|
||
/* Process the pieces. */
|
||
for (i = start; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0));
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 1));
|
||
unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
int shift = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
|
||
if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Arrange to shift the fragment to where it belongs.
|
||
extract_bit_field loads to the lsb of the reg. */
|
||
if (
|
||
#ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
|
||
BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_src), type, i == start)
|
||
== (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
|
||
#else
|
||
BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
||
bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
|
||
gcc_assert (bytelen > 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we won't be loading directly from memory, protect the real source
|
||
from strange tricks we might play; but make sure that the source can
|
||
be loaded directly into the destination. */
|
||
src = orig_src;
|
||
if (!MEM_P (orig_src)
|
||
&& (!CONSTANT_P (orig_src)
|
||
|| (GET_MODE (orig_src) != mode
|
||
&& GET_MODE (orig_src) != VOIDmode)))
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_MODE (orig_src) == VOIDmode)
|
||
src = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
||
else
|
||
src = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (orig_src));
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (src, orig_src);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Optimize the access just a bit. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (src)
|
||
&& (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (src))
|
||
|| MEM_ALIGN (src) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
|
||
&& bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
|
||
&& bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
||
emit_move_insn (tmps[i], adjust_address (src, mode, bytepos));
|
||
}
|
||
else if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode)
|
||
&& GET_MODE (src) == mode
|
||
&& bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
|
||
/* Let emit_move_complex do the bulk of the work. */
|
||
tmps[i] = src;
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (src) == CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
|
||
unsigned int slen0 = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (src, 0)));
|
||
|
||
if ((bytepos == 0 && bytelen == slen0)
|
||
|| (bytepos != 0 && bytepos + bytelen <= slen))
|
||
{
|
||
/* The following assumes that the concatenated objects all
|
||
have the same size. In this case, a simple calculation
|
||
can be used to determine the object and the bit field
|
||
to be extracted. */
|
||
tmps[i] = XEXP (src, bytepos / slen0);
|
||
if (! CONSTANT_P (tmps[i])
|
||
&& (!REG_P (tmps[i]) || GET_MODE (tmps[i]) != mode))
|
||
tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (tmps[i], bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
|
||
(bytepos % slen0) * BITS_PER_UNIT,
|
||
1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
rtx mem;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (!bytepos);
|
||
mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
|
||
emit_move_insn (mem, src);
|
||
tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (mem, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
|
||
0, 1, NULL_RTX, mode, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
/* FIXME: A SIMD parallel will eventually lead to a subreg of a
|
||
SIMD register, which is currently broken. While we get GCC
|
||
to emit proper RTL for these cases, let's dump to memory. */
|
||
else if (VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (dst))
|
||
&& REG_P (src))
|
||
{
|
||
int slen = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (src));
|
||
rtx mem;
|
||
|
||
mem = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (src), slen, 0);
|
||
emit_move_insn (mem, src);
|
||
tmps[i] = adjust_address (mem, mode, (int) bytepos);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (CONSTANT_P (src) && GET_MODE (dst) != BLKmode
|
||
&& XVECLEN (dst, 0) > 1)
|
||
tmps[i] = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, src, GET_MODE(dst), bytepos);
|
||
else if (CONSTANT_P (src)
|
||
|| (REG_P (src) && GET_MODE (src) == mode))
|
||
tmps[i] = src;
|
||
else
|
||
tmps[i] = extract_bit_field (src, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT,
|
||
bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT, 1, NULL_RTX,
|
||
mode, mode);
|
||
|
||
if (shift)
|
||
tmps[i] = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
|
||
build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, shift), tmps[i], 0);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Emit code to move a block SRC of type TYPE to a block DST,
|
||
where DST is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
|
||
SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_SRC in bytes, or -1
|
||
if not known. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
emit_group_load (rtx dst, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx *tmps;
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
tmps = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * XVECLEN (dst, 0));
|
||
emit_group_load_1 (tmps, dst, src, type, ssize);
|
||
|
||
/* Copy the extracted pieces into the proper (probable) hard regs. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (dst, 0); i++)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx d = XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0);
|
||
if (d == NULL)
|
||
continue;
|
||
emit_move_insn (d, tmps[i]);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Similar, but load SRC into new pseudos in a format that looks like
|
||
PARALLEL. This can later be fed to emit_group_move to get things
|
||
in the right place. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
emit_group_load_into_temps (rtx parallel, rtx src, tree type, int ssize)
|
||
{
|
||
rtvec vec;
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (parallel, 0));
|
||
emit_group_load_1 (&RTVEC_ELT (vec, 0), parallel, src, type, ssize);
|
||
|
||
/* Convert the vector to look just like the original PARALLEL, except
|
||
with the computed values. */
|
||
for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (parallel, 0); i++)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx e = XVECEXP (parallel, 0, i);
|
||
rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (d)
|
||
{
|
||
d = force_reg (GET_MODE (d), RTVEC_ELT (vec, i));
|
||
e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), d, XEXP (e, 1));
|
||
}
|
||
RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (parallel), vec);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Emit code to move a block SRC to block DST, where SRC and DST are
|
||
non-consecutive groups of registers, each represented by a PARALLEL. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
emit_group_move (rtx dst, rtx src)
|
||
{
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL
|
||
&& GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL
|
||
&& XVECLEN (src, 0) == XVECLEN (dst, 0));
|
||
|
||
/* Skip first entry if NULL. */
|
||
for (i = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0) ? 0 : 1; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
|
||
emit_move_insn (XEXP (XVECEXP (dst, 0, i), 0),
|
||
XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Move a group of registers represented by a PARALLEL into pseudos. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
emit_group_move_into_temps (rtx src)
|
||
{
|
||
rtvec vec = rtvec_alloc (XVECLEN (src, 0));
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (src, 0); i++)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx e = XVECEXP (src, 0, i);
|
||
rtx d = XEXP (e, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (d)
|
||
e = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_NOTE_KIND (e), copy_to_reg (d), XEXP (e, 1));
|
||
RTVEC_ELT (vec, i) = e;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (src), vec);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Emit code to move a block SRC to a block ORIG_DST of type TYPE,
|
||
where SRC is non-consecutive registers represented by a PARALLEL.
|
||
SSIZE represents the total size of block ORIG_DST, or -1 if not
|
||
known. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
emit_group_store (rtx orig_dst, rtx src, tree type ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, int ssize)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx *tmps, dst;
|
||
int start, finish, i;
|
||
enum machine_mode m = GET_MODE (orig_dst);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) == PARALLEL);
|
||
|
||
if (!SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (m)
|
||
&& !MEM_P (orig_dst) && GET_CODE (orig_dst) != CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode imode = int_mode_for_mode (GET_MODE (orig_dst));
|
||
if (imode == BLKmode)
|
||
dst = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (orig_dst), ssize, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
dst = gen_reg_rtx (imode);
|
||
emit_group_store (dst, src, type, ssize);
|
||
if (imode != BLKmode)
|
||
dst = gen_lowpart (GET_MODE (orig_dst), dst);
|
||
emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check for a NULL entry, used to indicate that the parameter goes
|
||
both on the stack and in registers. */
|
||
if (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, 0), 0))
|
||
start = 0;
|
||
else
|
||
start = 1;
|
||
finish = XVECLEN (src, 0);
|
||
|
||
tmps = alloca (sizeof (rtx) * finish);
|
||
|
||
/* Copy the (probable) hard regs into pseudos. */
|
||
for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 0);
|
||
if (!REG_P (reg) || REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
{
|
||
tmps[i] = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (reg));
|
||
emit_move_insn (tmps[i], reg);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
tmps[i] = reg;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we won't be storing directly into memory, protect the real destination
|
||
from strange tricks we might play. */
|
||
dst = orig_dst;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dst) == PARALLEL)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
|
||
/* We can get a PARALLEL dst if there is a conditional expression in
|
||
a return statement. In that case, the dst and src are the same,
|
||
so no action is necessary. */
|
||
if (rtx_equal_p (dst, src))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* It is unclear if we can ever reach here, but we may as well handle
|
||
it. Allocate a temporary, and split this into a store/load to/from
|
||
the temporary. */
|
||
|
||
temp = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dst), ssize, 0);
|
||
emit_group_store (temp, src, type, ssize);
|
||
emit_group_load (dst, temp, type, ssize);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (!MEM_P (dst) && GET_CODE (dst) != CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode outer = GET_MODE (dst);
|
||
enum machine_mode inner;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos;
|
||
bool done = false;
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
|
||
if (!REG_P (dst) || REGNO (dst) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
dst = gen_reg_rtx (outer);
|
||
|
||
/* Make life a bit easier for combine. */
|
||
/* If the first element of the vector is the low part
|
||
of the destination mode, use a paradoxical subreg to
|
||
initialize the destination. */
|
||
if (start < finish)
|
||
{
|
||
inner = GET_MODE (tmps[start]);
|
||
bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
|
||
if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, start), 1)) == bytepos)
|
||
{
|
||
temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[start],
|
||
inner, 0);
|
||
if (temp)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
|
||
done = true;
|
||
start++;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the first element wasn't the low part, try the last. */
|
||
if (!done
|
||
&& start < finish - 1)
|
||
{
|
||
inner = GET_MODE (tmps[finish - 1]);
|
||
bytepos = subreg_lowpart_offset (inner, outer);
|
||
if (INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, finish - 1), 1)) == bytepos)
|
||
{
|
||
temp = simplify_gen_subreg (outer, tmps[finish - 1],
|
||
inner, 0);
|
||
if (temp)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_move_insn (dst, temp);
|
||
done = true;
|
||
finish--;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, simply initialize the result to zero. */
|
||
if (!done)
|
||
emit_move_insn (dst, CONST0_RTX (outer));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Process the pieces. */
|
||
for (i = start; i < finish; i++)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bytepos = INTVAL (XEXP (XVECEXP (src, 0, i), 1));
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (tmps[i]);
|
||
unsigned int bytelen = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
rtx dest = dst;
|
||
|
||
/* Handle trailing fragments that run over the size of the struct. */
|
||
if (ssize >= 0 && bytepos + (HOST_WIDE_INT) bytelen > ssize)
|
||
{
|
||
/* store_bit_field always takes its value from the lsb.
|
||
Move the fragment to the lsb if it's not already there. */
|
||
if (
|
||
#ifdef BLOCK_REG_PADDING
|
||
BLOCK_REG_PADDING (GET_MODE (orig_dst), type, i == start)
|
||
== (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN ? upward : downward)
|
||
#else
|
||
BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
#endif
|
||
)
|
||
{
|
||
int shift = (bytelen - (ssize - bytepos)) * BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
||
tmps[i] = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, mode, tmps[i],
|
||
build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, shift),
|
||
tmps[i], 0);
|
||
}
|
||
bytelen = ssize - bytepos;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (dst) == CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
if (bytepos + bytelen <= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
|
||
dest = XEXP (dst, 0);
|
||
else if (bytepos >= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0))))
|
||
{
|
||
bytepos -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XEXP (dst, 0)));
|
||
dest = XEXP (dst, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (bytepos == 0 && XVECLEN (src, 0));
|
||
dest = assign_stack_temp (GET_MODE (dest),
|
||
GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest)), 0);
|
||
emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, GET_MODE (tmps[i]), bytepos),
|
||
tmps[i]);
|
||
dst = dest;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Optimize the access just a bit. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (dest)
|
||
&& (! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (dest))
|
||
|| MEM_ALIGN (dest) >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
|
||
&& bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) == 0
|
||
&& bytelen == GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
|
||
emit_move_insn (adjust_address (dest, mode, bytepos), tmps[i]);
|
||
else
|
||
store_bit_field (dest, bytelen * BITS_PER_UNIT, bytepos * BITS_PER_UNIT,
|
||
mode, tmps[i]);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Copy from the pseudo into the (probable) hard reg. */
|
||
if (orig_dst != dst)
|
||
emit_move_insn (orig_dst, dst);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate code to copy a BLKmode object of TYPE out of a
|
||
set of registers starting with SRCREG into TGTBLK. If TGTBLK
|
||
is null, a stack temporary is created. TGTBLK is returned.
|
||
|
||
The purpose of this routine is to handle functions that return
|
||
BLKmode structures in registers. Some machines (the PA for example)
|
||
want to return all small structures in registers regardless of the
|
||
structure's alignment. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
copy_blkmode_from_reg (rtx tgtblk, rtx srcreg, tree type)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
|
||
rtx src = NULL, dst = NULL;
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = MIN (TYPE_ALIGN (type), BITS_PER_WORD);
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, xbitpos, padding_correction = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (tgtblk == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
tgtblk = assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
|
||
(TYPE_QUALS (type)
|
||
| TYPE_QUAL_CONST)),
|
||
0, 1, 1);
|
||
preserve_temp_slots (tgtblk);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* This code assumes srcreg is at least a full word. If it isn't, copy it
|
||
into a new pseudo which is a full word. */
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE (srcreg) != BLKmode
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (srcreg)) < UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
srcreg = convert_to_mode (word_mode, srcreg, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
|
||
|
||
/* If the structure doesn't take up a whole number of words, see whether
|
||
SRCREG is padded on the left or on the right. If it's on the left,
|
||
set PADDING_CORRECTION to the number of bits to skip.
|
||
|
||
In most ABIs, the structure will be returned at the least end of
|
||
the register, which translates to right padding on little-endian
|
||
targets and left padding on big-endian targets. The opposite
|
||
holds if the structure is returned at the most significant
|
||
end of the register. */
|
||
if (bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD != 0
|
||
&& (targetm.calls.return_in_msb (type)
|
||
? !BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
: BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN))
|
||
padding_correction
|
||
= (BITS_PER_WORD - ((bytes % UNITS_PER_WORD) * BITS_PER_UNIT));
|
||
|
||
/* Copy the structure BITSIZE bites at a time.
|
||
|
||
We could probably emit more efficient code for machines which do not use
|
||
strict alignment, but it doesn't seem worth the effort at the current
|
||
time. */
|
||
for (bitpos = 0, xbitpos = padding_correction;
|
||
bitpos < bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
||
bitpos += bitsize, xbitpos += bitsize)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We need a new source operand each time xbitpos is on a
|
||
word boundary and when xbitpos == padding_correction
|
||
(the first time through). */
|
||
if (xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
|
||
|| xbitpos == padding_correction)
|
||
src = operand_subword_force (srcreg, xbitpos / BITS_PER_WORD,
|
||
GET_MODE (srcreg));
|
||
|
||
/* We need a new destination operand each time bitpos is on
|
||
a word boundary. */
|
||
if (bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0)
|
||
dst = operand_subword (tgtblk, bitpos / BITS_PER_WORD, 1, BLKmode);
|
||
|
||
/* Use xbitpos for the source extraction (right justified) and
|
||
xbitpos for the destination store (left justified). */
|
||
store_bit_field (dst, bitsize, bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, word_mode,
|
||
extract_bit_field (src, bitsize,
|
||
xbitpos % BITS_PER_WORD, 1,
|
||
NULL_RTX, word_mode, word_mode));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return tgtblk;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add a USE expression for REG to the (possibly empty) list pointed
|
||
to by CALL_FUSAGE. REG must denote a hard register. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
use_reg (rtx *call_fusage, rtx reg)
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (REG_P (reg) && REGNO (reg) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
|
||
|
||
*call_fusage
|
||
= gen_rtx_EXPR_LIST (VOIDmode,
|
||
gen_rtx_USE (VOIDmode, reg), *call_fusage);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each of NREGS consecutive regs,
|
||
starting at REGNO. All of these registers must be hard registers. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
use_regs (rtx *call_fusage, int regno, int nregs)
|
||
{
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (regno + nregs <= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < nregs; i++)
|
||
use_reg (call_fusage, regno_reg_rtx[regno + i]);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Add USE expressions to *CALL_FUSAGE for each REG contained in the
|
||
PARALLEL REGS. This is for calls that pass values in multiple
|
||
non-contiguous locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
use_group_regs (rtx *call_fusage, rtx regs)
|
||
{
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); i++)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx reg = XEXP (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i), 0);
|
||
|
||
/* A NULL entry means the parameter goes both on the stack and in
|
||
registers. This can also be a MEM for targets that pass values
|
||
partially on the stack and partially in registers. */
|
||
if (reg != 0 && REG_P (reg))
|
||
use_reg (call_fusage, reg);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Determine whether the LEN bytes generated by CONSTFUN can be
|
||
stored to memory using several move instructions. CONSTFUNDATA is
|
||
a pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
|
||
ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. Return nonzero if a
|
||
call to store_by_pieces should succeed. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
can_store_by_pieces (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
|
||
rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
|
||
void *constfundata, unsigned int align)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT l;
|
||
unsigned int max_size;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode, tmode;
|
||
enum insn_code icode;
|
||
int reverse;
|
||
rtx cst;
|
||
|
||
if (len == 0)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
if (! STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
tmode = mode_for_size (STORE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
|
||
if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
|
||
align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode xmode;
|
||
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode;
|
||
xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > STORE_MAX_PIECES
|
||
|| SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We would first store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
|
||
successively smaller modes. */
|
||
|
||
for (reverse = 0;
|
||
reverse <= (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT || HAVE_POST_DECREMENT);
|
||
reverse++)
|
||
{
|
||
l = len;
|
||
mode = VOIDmode;
|
||
max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
|
||
while (max_size > 1)
|
||
{
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
|
||
mode = tmode;
|
||
|
||
if (mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
|
||
if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing
|
||
&& align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
|
||
while (l >= size)
|
||
{
|
||
if (reverse)
|
||
offset -= size;
|
||
|
||
cst = (*constfun) (constfundata, offset, mode);
|
||
if (!LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (cst))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (!reverse)
|
||
offset += size;
|
||
|
||
l -= size;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The code above should have handled everything. */
|
||
gcc_assert (!l);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes generated by
|
||
CONSTFUN to block TO. (A MEM rtx with BLKmode). CONSTFUNDATA is a
|
||
pointer which will be passed as argument in every CONSTFUN call.
|
||
ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume.
|
||
If ENDP is 0 return to, if ENDP is 1 return memory at the end ala
|
||
mempcpy, and if ENDP is 2 return memory the end minus one byte ala
|
||
stpcpy. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
store_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len,
|
||
rtx (*constfun) (void *, HOST_WIDE_INT, enum machine_mode),
|
||
void *constfundata, unsigned int align, int endp)
|
||
{
|
||
struct store_by_pieces data;
|
||
|
||
if (len == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (endp != 2);
|
||
return to;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (STORE_BY_PIECES_P (len, align));
|
||
data.constfun = constfun;
|
||
data.constfundata = constfundata;
|
||
data.len = len;
|
||
data.to = to;
|
||
store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
|
||
if (endp)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx to1;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (!data.reverse);
|
||
if (data.autinc_to)
|
||
{
|
||
if (endp == 2)
|
||
{
|
||
if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data.explicit_inc_to > 0)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data.to_addr, constm1_rtx));
|
||
else
|
||
data.to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (data.to_addr,
|
||
-1));
|
||
}
|
||
to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data.to, QImode, data.to_addr,
|
||
data.offset);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (endp == 2)
|
||
--data.offset;
|
||
to1 = adjust_address (data.to, QImode, data.offset);
|
||
}
|
||
return to1;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return data.to;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate several move instructions to clear LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
|
||
rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
clear_by_pieces (rtx to, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT len, unsigned int align)
|
||
{
|
||
struct store_by_pieces data;
|
||
|
||
if (len == 0)
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
data.constfun = clear_by_pieces_1;
|
||
data.constfundata = NULL;
|
||
data.len = len;
|
||
data.to = to;
|
||
store_by_pieces_1 (&data, align);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Callback routine for clear_by_pieces.
|
||
Return const0_rtx unconditionally. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
clear_by_pieces_1 (void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
enum machine_mode mode ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Subroutine of clear_by_pieces and store_by_pieces.
|
||
Generate several move instructions to store LEN bytes of block TO. (A MEM
|
||
rtx with BLKmode). ALIGN is maximum alignment we can assume. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
store_by_pieces_1 (struct store_by_pieces *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
|
||
unsigned int align ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx to_addr = XEXP (data->to, 0);
|
||
unsigned int max_size = STORE_MAX_PIECES + 1;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode, tmode;
|
||
enum insn_code icode;
|
||
|
||
data->offset = 0;
|
||
data->to_addr = to_addr;
|
||
data->autinc_to
|
||
= (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC
|
||
|| GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_INC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
|
||
|
||
data->explicit_inc_to = 0;
|
||
data->reverse
|
||
= (GET_CODE (to_addr) == PRE_DEC || GET_CODE (to_addr) == POST_DEC);
|
||
if (data->reverse)
|
||
data->offset = data->len;
|
||
|
||
/* If storing requires more than two move insns,
|
||
copy addresses to registers (to make displacements shorter)
|
||
and use post-increment if available. */
|
||
if (!data->autinc_to
|
||
&& move_by_pieces_ninsns (data->len, align, max_size) > 2)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Determine the main mode we'll be using. */
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
|
||
mode = tmode;
|
||
|
||
if (USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (mode) && data->reverse && ! data->autinc_to)
|
||
{
|
||
data->to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (plus_constant (to_addr, data->len));
|
||
data->autinc_to = 1;
|
||
data->explicit_inc_to = -1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (mode) && ! data->reverse
|
||
&& ! data->autinc_to)
|
||
{
|
||
data->to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
|
||
data->autinc_to = 1;
|
||
data->explicit_inc_to = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if ( !data->autinc_to && CONSTANT_P (to_addr))
|
||
data->to_addr = copy_addr_to_reg (to_addr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
tmode = mode_for_size (STORE_MAX_PIECES * BITS_PER_UNIT, MODE_INT, 1);
|
||
if (align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode))
|
||
align = GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (tmode);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode xmode;
|
||
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), xmode = tmode;
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode;
|
||
xmode = tmode, tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) > STORE_MAX_PIECES
|
||
|| SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (tmode, align))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
align = MAX (align, GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (xmode));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* First store what we can in the largest integer mode, then go to
|
||
successively smaller modes. */
|
||
|
||
while (max_size > 1)
|
||
{
|
||
for (tmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT);
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode; tmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (tmode))
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (tmode) < max_size)
|
||
mode = tmode;
|
||
|
||
if (mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
icode = mov_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
|
||
if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing && align >= GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
|
||
store_by_pieces_2 (GEN_FCN (icode), mode, data);
|
||
|
||
max_size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The code above should have handled everything. */
|
||
gcc_assert (!data->len);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Subroutine of store_by_pieces_1. Store as many bytes as appropriate
|
||
with move instructions for mode MODE. GENFUN is the gen_... function
|
||
to make a move insn for that mode. DATA has all the other info. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
store_by_pieces_2 (rtx (*genfun) (rtx, ...), enum machine_mode mode,
|
||
struct store_by_pieces *data)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
rtx to1, cst;
|
||
|
||
while (data->len >= size)
|
||
{
|
||
if (data->reverse)
|
||
data->offset -= size;
|
||
|
||
if (data->autinc_to)
|
||
to1 = adjust_automodify_address (data->to, mode, data->to_addr,
|
||
data->offset);
|
||
else
|
||
to1 = adjust_address (data->to, mode, data->offset);
|
||
|
||
if (HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to < 0)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr,
|
||
GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) size)));
|
||
|
||
cst = (*data->constfun) (data->constfundata, data->offset, mode);
|
||
emit_insn ((*genfun) (to1, cst));
|
||
|
||
if (HAVE_POST_INCREMENT && data->explicit_inc_to > 0)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_add2_insn (data->to_addr, GEN_INT (size)));
|
||
|
||
if (! data->reverse)
|
||
data->offset += size;
|
||
|
||
data->len -= size;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Write zeros through the storage of OBJECT. If OBJECT has BLKmode, SIZE is
|
||
its length in bytes. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
clear_storage (rtx object, rtx size, enum block_op_methods method)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (object);
|
||
unsigned int align;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (method == BLOCK_OP_NORMAL || method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
|
||
|
||
/* If OBJECT is not BLKmode and SIZE is the same size as its mode,
|
||
just move a zero. Otherwise, do this a piece at a time. */
|
||
if (mode != BLKmode
|
||
&& GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (size) == (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx zero = CONST0_RTX (mode);
|
||
if (zero != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_move_insn (object, zero);
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
zero = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
|
||
if (zero != NULL)
|
||
{
|
||
write_complex_part (object, zero, 0);
|
||
write_complex_part (object, zero, 1);
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (size == const0_rtx)
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
|
||
align = MEM_ALIGN (object);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& CLEAR_BY_PIECES_P (INTVAL (size), align))
|
||
clear_by_pieces (object, INTVAL (size), align);
|
||
else if (set_storage_via_setmem (object, size, const0_rtx, align))
|
||
;
|
||
else
|
||
return clear_storage_via_libcall (object, size,
|
||
method == BLOCK_OP_TAILCALL);
|
||
|
||
return NULL;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of clear_storage. Expand a call to memset.
|
||
Return the return value of memset, 0 otherwise. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
clear_storage_via_libcall (rtx object, rtx size, bool tailcall)
|
||
{
|
||
tree call_expr, arg_list, fn, object_tree, size_tree;
|
||
enum machine_mode size_mode;
|
||
rtx retval;
|
||
|
||
/* Emit code to copy OBJECT and SIZE into new pseudos. We can then
|
||
place those into new pseudos into a VAR_DECL and use them later. */
|
||
|
||
object = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, XEXP (object, 0));
|
||
|
||
size_mode = TYPE_MODE (sizetype);
|
||
size = convert_to_mode (size_mode, size, 1);
|
||
size = copy_to_mode_reg (size_mode, size);
|
||
|
||
/* It is incorrect to use the libcall calling conventions to call
|
||
memset in this context. This could be a user call to memset and
|
||
the user may wish to examine the return value from memset. For
|
||
targets where libcalls and normal calls have different conventions
|
||
for returning pointers, we could end up generating incorrect code. */
|
||
|
||
object_tree = make_tree (ptr_type_node, object);
|
||
size_tree = make_tree (sizetype, size);
|
||
|
||
fn = clear_storage_libcall_fn (true);
|
||
arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, size_tree, NULL_TREE);
|
||
arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, integer_zero_node, arg_list);
|
||
arg_list = tree_cons (NULL_TREE, object_tree, arg_list);
|
||
|
||
/* Now we have to build up the CALL_EXPR itself. */
|
||
call_expr = build1 (ADDR_EXPR, build_pointer_type (TREE_TYPE (fn)), fn);
|
||
call_expr = build3 (CALL_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (fn)),
|
||
call_expr, arg_list, NULL_TREE);
|
||
CALL_EXPR_TAILCALL (call_expr) = tailcall;
|
||
|
||
retval = expand_normal (call_expr);
|
||
|
||
return retval;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of clear_storage_via_libcall. Create the tree node
|
||
for the function we use for block clears. The first time FOR_CALL
|
||
is true, we call assemble_external. */
|
||
|
||
static GTY(()) tree block_clear_fn;
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
init_block_clear_fn (const char *asmspec)
|
||
{
|
||
if (!block_clear_fn)
|
||
{
|
||
tree fn, args;
|
||
|
||
fn = get_identifier ("memset");
|
||
args = build_function_type_list (ptr_type_node, ptr_type_node,
|
||
integer_type_node, sizetype,
|
||
NULL_TREE);
|
||
|
||
fn = build_decl (FUNCTION_DECL, fn, args);
|
||
DECL_EXTERNAL (fn) = 1;
|
||
TREE_PUBLIC (fn) = 1;
|
||
DECL_ARTIFICIAL (fn) = 1;
|
||
TREE_NOTHROW (fn) = 1;
|
||
DECL_VISIBILITY (fn) = VISIBILITY_DEFAULT;
|
||
DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED (fn) = 1;
|
||
|
||
block_clear_fn = fn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (asmspec)
|
||
set_user_assembler_name (block_clear_fn, asmspec);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static tree
|
||
clear_storage_libcall_fn (int for_call)
|
||
{
|
||
static bool emitted_extern;
|
||
|
||
if (!block_clear_fn)
|
||
init_block_clear_fn (NULL);
|
||
|
||
if (for_call && !emitted_extern)
|
||
{
|
||
emitted_extern = true;
|
||
make_decl_rtl (block_clear_fn);
|
||
assemble_external (block_clear_fn);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return block_clear_fn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Expand a setmem pattern; return true if successful. */
|
||
|
||
bool
|
||
set_storage_via_setmem (rtx object, rtx size, rtx val, unsigned int align)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Try the most limited insn first, because there's no point
|
||
including more than one in the machine description unless
|
||
the more limited one has some advantage. */
|
||
|
||
rtx opalign = GEN_INT (align / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
|
||
for (mode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT); mode != VOIDmode;
|
||
mode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
enum insn_code code = setmem_optab[(int) mode];
|
||
insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
|
||
|
||
if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing
|
||
/* We don't need MODE to be narrower than
|
||
BITS_PER_HOST_WIDE_INT here because if SIZE is less than
|
||
the mode mask, as it is returned by the macro, it will
|
||
definitely be less than the actual mode mask. */
|
||
&& ((GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) INTVAL (size)
|
||
<= (GET_MODE_MASK (mode) >> 1)))
|
||
|| GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) >= BITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
&& ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[0].predicate) == 0
|
||
|| (*pred) (object, BLKmode))
|
||
&& ((pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[3].predicate) == 0
|
||
|| (*pred) (opalign, VOIDmode)))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx opsize, opchar;
|
||
enum machine_mode char_mode;
|
||
rtx last = get_last_insn ();
|
||
rtx pat;
|
||
|
||
opsize = convert_to_mode (mode, size, 1);
|
||
pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[1].predicate;
|
||
if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (opsize, mode))
|
||
opsize = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, opsize);
|
||
|
||
opchar = val;
|
||
char_mode = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].mode;
|
||
if (char_mode != VOIDmode)
|
||
{
|
||
opchar = convert_to_mode (char_mode, opchar, 1);
|
||
pred = insn_data[(int) code].operand[2].predicate;
|
||
if (pred != 0 && ! (*pred) (opchar, char_mode))
|
||
opchar = copy_to_mode_reg (char_mode, opchar);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
pat = GEN_FCN ((int) code) (object, opsize, opchar, opalign);
|
||
if (pat)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_insn (pat);
|
||
return true;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
delete_insns_since (last);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return false;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Write to one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Write VAL to
|
||
the real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if its true. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
write_complex_part (rtx cplx, rtx val, bool imag_p)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode cmode;
|
||
enum machine_mode imode;
|
||
unsigned ibitsize;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_move_insn (XEXP (cplx, imag_p), val);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
|
||
imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
|
||
ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
|
||
|
||
/* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
|
||
because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
|
||
by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
|
||
adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
|
||
invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (cplx))
|
||
{
|
||
emit_move_insn (adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
|
||
imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0),
|
||
val);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
|
||
will work. This special case is important, since store_bit_field
|
||
wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
|
||
correspond to TCmode. */
|
||
if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
|
||
/* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
|
||
the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
|
||
This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
|
||
where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
|
||
|| (REG_P (cplx)
|
||
&& REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
&& hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx part = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
|
||
imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
|
||
if (part)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_move_insn (part, val);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
/* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
|
||
gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
store_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0, imode, val);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Extract one of the components of the complex value CPLX. Extract the
|
||
real part if IMAG_P is false, and the imaginary part if it's true. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
read_complex_part (rtx cplx, bool imag_p)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode cmode, imode;
|
||
unsigned ibitsize;
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (cplx) == CONCAT)
|
||
return XEXP (cplx, imag_p);
|
||
|
||
cmode = GET_MODE (cplx);
|
||
imode = GET_MODE_INNER (cmode);
|
||
ibitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode);
|
||
|
||
/* Special case reads from complex constants that got spilled to memory. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (cplx) && GET_CODE (XEXP (cplx, 0)) == SYMBOL_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
tree decl = SYMBOL_REF_DECL (XEXP (cplx, 0));
|
||
if (decl && TREE_CODE (decl) == COMPLEX_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
tree part = imag_p ? TREE_IMAGPART (decl) : TREE_REALPART (decl);
|
||
if (CONSTANT_CLASS_P (part))
|
||
return expand_expr (part, NULL_RTX, imode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* For MEMs simplify_gen_subreg may generate an invalid new address
|
||
because, e.g., the original address is considered mode-dependent
|
||
by the target, which restricts simplify_subreg from invoking
|
||
adjust_address_nv. Instead of preparing fallback support for an
|
||
invalid address, we call adjust_address_nv directly. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (cplx))
|
||
return adjust_address_nv (cplx, imode,
|
||
imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
|
||
|
||
/* If the sub-object is at least word sized, then we know that subregging
|
||
will work. This special case is important, since extract_bit_field
|
||
wants to operate on integer modes, and there's rarely an OImode to
|
||
correspond to TCmode. */
|
||
if (ibitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
|
||
/* For hard regs we have exact predicates. Assume we can split
|
||
the original object if it spans an even number of hard regs.
|
||
This special case is important for SCmode on 64-bit platforms
|
||
where the natural size of floating-point regs is 32-bit. */
|
||
|| (REG_P (cplx)
|
||
&& REGNO (cplx) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
&& hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (cplx)][cmode] % 2 == 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx ret = simplify_gen_subreg (imode, cplx, cmode,
|
||
imag_p ? GET_MODE_SIZE (imode) : 0);
|
||
if (ret)
|
||
return ret;
|
||
else
|
||
/* simplify_gen_subreg may fail for sub-word MEMs. */
|
||
gcc_assert (MEM_P (cplx) && ibitsize < BITS_PER_WORD);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return extract_bit_field (cplx, ibitsize, imag_p ? ibitsize : 0,
|
||
true, NULL_RTX, imode, imode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Yet another lowpart generator.
|
||
NEW_MODE and OLD_MODE are the same size. Return NULL if X cannot be
|
||
represented in NEW_MODE. If FORCE is true, this will never happen, as
|
||
we'll force-create a SUBREG if needed. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
emit_move_change_mode (enum machine_mode new_mode,
|
||
enum machine_mode old_mode, rtx x, bool force)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx ret;
|
||
|
||
if (MEM_P (x))
|
||
{
|
||
/* We don't have to worry about changing the address since the
|
||
size in bytes is supposed to be the same. */
|
||
if (reload_in_progress)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Copy the MEM to change the mode and move any
|
||
substitutions from the old MEM to the new one. */
|
||
ret = adjust_address_nv (x, new_mode, 0);
|
||
copy_replacements (x, ret);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
ret = adjust_address (x, new_mode, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Note that we do want simplify_subreg's behavior of validating
|
||
that the new mode is ok for a hard register. If we were to use
|
||
simplify_gen_subreg, we would create the subreg, but would
|
||
probably run into the target not being able to implement it. */
|
||
/* Except, of course, when FORCE is true, when this is exactly what
|
||
we want. Which is needed for CCmodes on some targets. */
|
||
if (force)
|
||
ret = simplify_gen_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
ret = simplify_subreg (new_mode, x, old_mode, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X using
|
||
an integer mode of the same size as MODE. Returns the instruction
|
||
emitted, or NULL if such a move could not be generated. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
emit_move_via_integer (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y, bool force)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode imode;
|
||
enum insn_code code;
|
||
|
||
/* There must exist a mode of the exact size we require. */
|
||
imode = int_mode_for_mode (mode);
|
||
if (imode == BLKmode)
|
||
return NULL_RTX;
|
||
|
||
/* The target must support moves in this mode. */
|
||
code = mov_optab->handlers[imode].insn_code;
|
||
if (code == CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
return NULL_RTX;
|
||
|
||
x = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, x, force);
|
||
if (x == NULL_RTX)
|
||
return NULL_RTX;
|
||
y = emit_move_change_mode (imode, mode, y, force);
|
||
if (y == NULL_RTX)
|
||
return NULL_RTX;
|
||
return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. X is a push_operand in MODE.
|
||
Return an equivalent MEM that does not use an auto-increment. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
emit_move_resolve_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x)
|
||
{
|
||
enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0));
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT adjust;
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
|
||
adjust = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
|
||
adjust = PUSH_ROUNDING (adjust);
|
||
#endif
|
||
if (code == PRE_DEC || code == POST_DEC)
|
||
adjust = -adjust;
|
||
else if (code == PRE_MODIFY || code == POST_MODIFY)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx expr = XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 1);
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT val;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == PLUS || GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS);
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (expr, 1)) == CONST_INT);
|
||
val = INTVAL (XEXP (expr, 1));
|
||
if (GET_CODE (expr) == MINUS)
|
||
val = -val;
|
||
gcc_assert (adjust == val || adjust == -val);
|
||
adjust = val;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Do not use anti_adjust_stack, since we don't want to update
|
||
stack_pointer_delta. */
|
||
temp = expand_simple_binop (Pmode, PLUS, stack_pointer_rtx,
|
||
GEN_INT (adjust), stack_pointer_rtx,
|
||
0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
if (temp != stack_pointer_rtx)
|
||
emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx, temp);
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case PRE_INC:
|
||
case PRE_DEC:
|
||
case PRE_MODIFY:
|
||
temp = stack_pointer_rtx;
|
||
break;
|
||
case POST_INC:
|
||
case POST_DEC:
|
||
case POST_MODIFY:
|
||
temp = plus_constant (stack_pointer_rtx, -adjust);
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return replace_equiv_address (x, temp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_move_complex. Generate a move from Y into X.
|
||
X is known to satisfy push_operand, and MODE is known to be complex.
|
||
Returns the last instruction emitted. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
emit_move_complex_push (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode submode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
|
||
bool imag_first;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
|
||
unsigned int submodesize = GET_MODE_SIZE (submode);
|
||
|
||
/* In case we output to the stack, but the size is smaller than the
|
||
machine can push exactly, we need to use move instructions. */
|
||
if (PUSH_ROUNDING (submodesize) != submodesize)
|
||
{
|
||
x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
|
||
return emit_move_insn (x, y);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Note that the real part always precedes the imag part in memory
|
||
regardless of machine's endianness. */
|
||
switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)))
|
||
{
|
||
case PRE_DEC:
|
||
case POST_DEC:
|
||
imag_first = true;
|
||
break;
|
||
case PRE_INC:
|
||
case POST_INC:
|
||
imag_first = false;
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
|
||
read_complex_part (y, imag_first));
|
||
return emit_move_insn (gen_rtx_MEM (submode, XEXP (x, 0)),
|
||
read_complex_part (y, !imag_first));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
|
||
MODE is known to be complex. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
emit_move_complex (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
|
||
{
|
||
bool try_int;
|
||
|
||
/* Need to take special care for pushes, to maintain proper ordering
|
||
of the data, and possibly extra padding. */
|
||
if (push_operand (x, mode))
|
||
return emit_move_complex_push (mode, x, y);
|
||
|
||
/* See if we can coerce the target into moving both values at once. */
|
||
|
||
/* Move floating point as parts. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
|
||
&& mov_optab->handlers[GET_MODE_INNER (mode)].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
try_int = false;
|
||
/* Not possible if the values are inherently not adjacent. */
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (x) == CONCAT || GET_CODE (y) == CONCAT)
|
||
try_int = false;
|
||
/* Is possible if both are registers (or subregs of registers). */
|
||
else if (register_operand (x, mode) && register_operand (y, mode))
|
||
try_int = true;
|
||
/* If one of the operands is a memory, and alignment constraints
|
||
are friendly enough, we may be able to do combined memory operations.
|
||
We do not attempt this if Y is a constant because that combination is
|
||
usually better with the by-parts thing below. */
|
||
else if ((MEM_P (x) ? !CONSTANT_P (y) : MEM_P (y))
|
||
&& (!STRICT_ALIGNMENT
|
||
|| get_mode_alignment (mode) == BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT))
|
||
try_int = true;
|
||
else
|
||
try_int = false;
|
||
|
||
if (try_int)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx ret;
|
||
|
||
/* For memory to memory moves, optimal behavior can be had with the
|
||
existing block move logic. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (y))
|
||
{
|
||
emit_block_move (x, y, GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode)),
|
||
BLOCK_OP_NO_LIBCALL);
|
||
return get_last_insn ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
|
||
if (ret)
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
|
||
of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
|
||
hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values. */
|
||
if (!reload_completed && !reload_in_progress
|
||
&& REG_P (x) && !reg_overlap_mentioned_p (x, y))
|
||
emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, x));
|
||
|
||
write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, false), false);
|
||
write_complex_part (x, read_complex_part (y, true), true);
|
||
return get_last_insn ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
|
||
MODE is known to be MODE_CC. Returns the last instruction emitted. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
emit_move_ccmode (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx ret;
|
||
|
||
/* Assume all MODE_CC modes are equivalent; if we have movcc, use it. */
|
||
if (mode != CCmode)
|
||
{
|
||
enum insn_code code = mov_optab->handlers[CCmode].insn_code;
|
||
if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
{
|
||
x = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, x, true);
|
||
y = emit_move_change_mode (CCmode, mode, y, true);
|
||
return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, find the MODE_INT mode of the same width. */
|
||
ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
|
||
gcc_assert (ret != NULL);
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return true if word I of OP lies entirely in the
|
||
undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
|
||
|
||
static bool
|
||
undefined_operand_subword_p (rtx op, int i)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode innermode, innermostmode;
|
||
int offset;
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op) != SUBREG)
|
||
return false;
|
||
innermode = GET_MODE (op);
|
||
innermostmode = GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (op));
|
||
offset = i * UNITS_PER_WORD + SUBREG_BYTE (op);
|
||
/* The SUBREG_BYTE represents offset, as if the value were stored in
|
||
memory, except for a paradoxical subreg where we define
|
||
SUBREG_BYTE to be 0; undo this exception as in
|
||
simplify_subreg. */
|
||
if (SUBREG_BYTE (op) == 0
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) < GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode))
|
||
{
|
||
int difference = (GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode) - GET_MODE_SIZE (innermode));
|
||
if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
||
offset += (difference / UNITS_PER_WORD) * UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
||
offset += difference % UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
}
|
||
if (offset >= GET_MODE_SIZE (innermostmode)
|
||
|| offset <= -GET_MODE_SIZE (word_mode))
|
||
return true;
|
||
return false;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of emit_move_insn_1. Generate a move from Y into X.
|
||
MODE is any multi-word or full-word mode that lacks a move_insn
|
||
pattern. Note that you will get better code if you define such
|
||
patterns, even if they must turn into multiple assembler instructions. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
emit_move_multi_word (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, rtx y)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx last_insn = 0;
|
||
rtx seq, inner;
|
||
bool need_clobber;
|
||
int i;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) >= UNITS_PER_WORD);
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a push on the stack, do the push now and replace
|
||
X with a reference to the stack pointer. */
|
||
if (push_operand (x, mode))
|
||
x = emit_move_resolve_push (mode, x);
|
||
|
||
/* If we are in reload, see if either operand is a MEM whose address
|
||
is scheduled for replacement. */
|
||
if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (x)
|
||
&& (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (x, 0))) != XEXP (x, 0))
|
||
x = replace_equiv_address_nv (x, inner);
|
||
if (reload_in_progress && MEM_P (y)
|
||
&& (inner = find_replacement (&XEXP (y, 0))) != XEXP (y, 0))
|
||
y = replace_equiv_address_nv (y, inner);
|
||
|
||
start_sequence ();
|
||
|
||
need_clobber = false;
|
||
for (i = 0;
|
||
i < (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) + (UNITS_PER_WORD - 1)) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
i++)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx xpart = operand_subword (x, i, 1, mode);
|
||
rtx ypart;
|
||
|
||
/* Do not generate code for a move if it would come entirely
|
||
from the undefined bits of a paradoxical subreg. */
|
||
if (undefined_operand_subword_p (y, i))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
|
||
|
||
/* If we can't get a part of Y, put Y into memory if it is a
|
||
constant. Otherwise, force it into a register. Then we must
|
||
be able to get a part of Y. */
|
||
if (ypart == 0 && CONSTANT_P (y))
|
||
{
|
||
y = use_anchored_address (force_const_mem (mode, y));
|
||
ypart = operand_subword (y, i, 1, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (ypart == 0)
|
||
ypart = operand_subword_force (y, i, mode);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (xpart && ypart);
|
||
|
||
need_clobber |= (GET_CODE (xpart) == SUBREG);
|
||
|
||
last_insn = emit_move_insn (xpart, ypart);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
seq = get_insns ();
|
||
end_sequence ();
|
||
|
||
/* Show the output dies here. This is necessary for SUBREGs
|
||
of pseudos since we cannot track their lifetimes correctly;
|
||
hard regs shouldn't appear here except as return values.
|
||
We never want to emit such a clobber after reload. */
|
||
if (x != y
|
||
&& ! (reload_in_progress || reload_completed)
|
||
&& need_clobber != 0)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, x));
|
||
|
||
emit_insn (seq);
|
||
|
||
return last_insn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Low level part of emit_move_insn.
|
||
Called just like emit_move_insn, but assumes X and Y
|
||
are basically valid. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
emit_move_insn_1 (rtx x, rtx y)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
|
||
enum insn_code code;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert ((unsigned int) mode < (unsigned int) MAX_MACHINE_MODE);
|
||
|
||
code = mov_optab->handlers[mode].insn_code;
|
||
if (code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
return emit_insn (GEN_FCN (code) (x, y));
|
||
|
||
/* Expand complex moves by moving real part and imag part. */
|
||
if (COMPLEX_MODE_P (mode))
|
||
return emit_move_complex (mode, x, y);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_DECIMAL_FLOAT)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx result = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, true);
|
||
|
||
/* If we can't find an integer mode, use multi words. */
|
||
if (result)
|
||
return result;
|
||
else
|
||
return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_CC)
|
||
return emit_move_ccmode (mode, x, y);
|
||
|
||
/* Try using a move pattern for the corresponding integer mode. This is
|
||
only safe when simplify_subreg can convert MODE constants into integer
|
||
constants. At present, it can only do this reliably if the value
|
||
fits within a HOST_WIDE_INT. */
|
||
if (!CONSTANT_P (y) || GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx ret = emit_move_via_integer (mode, x, y, false);
|
||
if (ret)
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return emit_move_multi_word (mode, x, y);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate code to copy Y into X.
|
||
Both Y and X must have the same mode, except that
|
||
Y can be a constant with VOIDmode.
|
||
This mode cannot be BLKmode; use emit_block_move for that.
|
||
|
||
Return the last instruction emitted. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
emit_move_insn (rtx x, rtx y)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (x);
|
||
rtx y_cst = NULL_RTX;
|
||
rtx last_insn, set;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode
|
||
&& (GET_MODE (y) == mode || GET_MODE (y) == VOIDmode));
|
||
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (y))
|
||
{
|
||
if (optimize
|
||
&& SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (x))
|
||
&& (last_insn = compress_float_constant (x, y)))
|
||
return last_insn;
|
||
|
||
y_cst = y;
|
||
|
||
if (!LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (y))
|
||
{
|
||
y = force_const_mem (mode, y);
|
||
|
||
/* If the target's cannot_force_const_mem prevented the spill,
|
||
assume that the target's move expanders will also take care
|
||
of the non-legitimate constant. */
|
||
if (!y)
|
||
y = y_cst;
|
||
else
|
||
y = use_anchored_address (y);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If X or Y are memory references, verify that their addresses are valid
|
||
for the machine. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (x)
|
||
&& ((! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (x), XEXP (x, 0))
|
||
&& ! push_operand (x, GET_MODE (x)))
|
||
|| (flag_force_addr
|
||
&& CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (x, 0)))))
|
||
x = validize_mem (x);
|
||
|
||
if (MEM_P (y)
|
||
&& (! memory_address_p (GET_MODE (y), XEXP (y, 0))
|
||
|| (flag_force_addr
|
||
&& CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (XEXP (y, 0)))))
|
||
y = validize_mem (y);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (mode != BLKmode);
|
||
|
||
last_insn = emit_move_insn_1 (x, y);
|
||
|
||
if (y_cst && REG_P (x)
|
||
&& (set = single_set (last_insn)) != NULL_RTX
|
||
&& SET_DEST (set) == x
|
||
&& ! rtx_equal_p (y_cst, SET_SRC (set)))
|
||
set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y_cst);
|
||
|
||
return last_insn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If Y is representable exactly in a narrower mode, and the target can
|
||
perform the extension directly from constant or memory, then emit the
|
||
move as an extension. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
compress_float_constant (rtx x, rtx y)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode dstmode = GET_MODE (x);
|
||
enum machine_mode orig_srcmode = GET_MODE (y);
|
||
enum machine_mode srcmode;
|
||
REAL_VALUE_TYPE r;
|
||
int oldcost, newcost;
|
||
|
||
REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (r, y);
|
||
|
||
if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (y))
|
||
oldcost = rtx_cost (y, SET);
|
||
else
|
||
oldcost = rtx_cost (force_const_mem (dstmode, y), SET);
|
||
|
||
for (srcmode = GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (GET_MODE_CLASS (orig_srcmode));
|
||
srcmode != orig_srcmode;
|
||
srcmode = GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (srcmode))
|
||
{
|
||
enum insn_code ic;
|
||
rtx trunc_y, last_insn;
|
||
|
||
/* Skip if the target can't extend this way. */
|
||
ic = can_extend_p (dstmode, srcmode, 0);
|
||
if (ic == CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
/* Skip if the narrowed value isn't exact. */
|
||
if (! exact_real_truncate (srcmode, &r))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
trunc_y = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (r, srcmode);
|
||
|
||
if (LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (trunc_y))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Skip if the target needs extra instructions to perform
|
||
the extension. */
|
||
if (! (*insn_data[ic].operand[1].predicate) (trunc_y, srcmode))
|
||
continue;
|
||
/* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
|
||
newcost = rtx_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y), SET);
|
||
if (oldcost < newcost)
|
||
continue;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (float_extend_from_mem[dstmode][srcmode])
|
||
{
|
||
trunc_y = force_const_mem (srcmode, trunc_y);
|
||
/* This is valid, but may not be cheaper than the original. */
|
||
newcost = rtx_cost (gen_rtx_FLOAT_EXTEND (dstmode, trunc_y), SET);
|
||
if (oldcost < newcost)
|
||
continue;
|
||
trunc_y = validize_mem (trunc_y);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
/* For CSE's benefit, force the compressed constant pool entry
|
||
into a new pseudo. This constant may be used in different modes,
|
||
and if not, combine will put things back together for us. */
|
||
trunc_y = force_reg (srcmode, trunc_y);
|
||
emit_unop_insn (ic, x, trunc_y, UNKNOWN);
|
||
last_insn = get_last_insn ();
|
||
|
||
if (REG_P (x))
|
||
set_unique_reg_note (last_insn, REG_EQUAL, y);
|
||
|
||
return last_insn;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return NULL_RTX;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Pushing data onto the stack. */
|
||
|
||
/* Push a block of length SIZE (perhaps variable)
|
||
and return an rtx to address the beginning of the block.
|
||
The value may be virtual_outgoing_args_rtx.
|
||
|
||
EXTRA is the number of bytes of padding to push in addition to SIZE.
|
||
BELOW nonzero means this padding comes at low addresses;
|
||
otherwise, the padding comes at high addresses. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
push_block (rtx size, int extra, int below)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
|
||
size = convert_modes (Pmode, ptr_mode, size, 1);
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (size))
|
||
anti_adjust_stack (plus_constant (size, extra));
|
||
else if (REG_P (size) && extra == 0)
|
||
anti_adjust_stack (size);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
temp = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, size);
|
||
if (extra != 0)
|
||
temp = expand_binop (Pmode, add_optab, temp, GEN_INT (extra),
|
||
temp, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
anti_adjust_stack (temp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
if (0)
|
||
#else
|
||
if (1)
|
||
#endif
|
||
{
|
||
temp = virtual_outgoing_args_rtx;
|
||
if (extra != 0 && below)
|
||
temp = plus_constant (temp, extra);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
|
||
temp = plus_constant (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
|
||
-INTVAL (size) - (below ? 0 : extra));
|
||
else if (extra != 0 && !below)
|
||
temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
|
||
negate_rtx (Pmode, plus_constant (size, extra)));
|
||
else
|
||
temp = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, virtual_outgoing_args_rtx,
|
||
negate_rtx (Pmode, size));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return memory_address (GET_CLASS_NARROWEST_MODE (MODE_INT), temp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
|
||
|
||
/* Emit single push insn. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
emit_single_push_insn (enum machine_mode mode, rtx x, tree type)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx dest_addr;
|
||
unsigned rounded_size = PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
|
||
rtx dest;
|
||
enum insn_code icode;
|
||
insn_operand_predicate_fn pred;
|
||
|
||
stack_pointer_delta += PUSH_ROUNDING (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
|
||
/* If there is push pattern, use it. Otherwise try old way of throwing
|
||
MEM representing push operation to move expander. */
|
||
icode = push_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code;
|
||
if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
{
|
||
if (((pred = insn_data[(int) icode].operand[0].predicate)
|
||
&& !((*pred) (x, mode))))
|
||
x = force_reg (mode, x);
|
||
emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode) (x));
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
if (GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == rounded_size)
|
||
dest_addr = gen_rtx_fmt_e (STACK_PUSH_CODE, Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx);
|
||
/* If we are to pad downward, adjust the stack pointer first and
|
||
then store X into the stack location using an offset. This is
|
||
because emit_move_insn does not know how to pad; it does not have
|
||
access to type. */
|
||
else if (FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type) == downward)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned padding_size = rounded_size - GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (stack_pointer_rtx,
|
||
expand_binop (Pmode,
|
||
#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
sub_optab,
|
||
#else
|
||
add_optab,
|
||
#endif
|
||
stack_pointer_rtx,
|
||
GEN_INT (rounded_size),
|
||
NULL_RTX, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN));
|
||
|
||
offset = (HOST_WIDE_INT) padding_size;
|
||
#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
|
||
/* We have already decremented the stack pointer, so get the
|
||
previous value. */
|
||
offset += (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
|
||
#else
|
||
if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC)
|
||
/* We have already incremented the stack pointer, so get the
|
||
previous value. */
|
||
offset -= (HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size;
|
||
#endif
|
||
dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, GEN_INT (offset));
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
/* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC. */
|
||
dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
|
||
GEN_INT (-(HOST_WIDE_INT) rounded_size));
|
||
#else
|
||
/* ??? This seems wrong if STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_INC. */
|
||
dest_addr = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx,
|
||
GEN_INT (rounded_size));
|
||
#endif
|
||
dest_addr = gen_rtx_PRE_MODIFY (Pmode, stack_pointer_rtx, dest_addr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, dest_addr);
|
||
|
||
if (type != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
set_mem_attributes (dest, type, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (flag_optimize_sibling_calls)
|
||
/* Function incoming arguments may overlap with sibling call
|
||
outgoing arguments and we cannot allow reordering of reads
|
||
from function arguments with stores to outgoing arguments
|
||
of sibling calls. */
|
||
set_mem_alias_set (dest, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
emit_move_insn (dest, x);
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Generate code to push X onto the stack, assuming it has mode MODE and
|
||
type TYPE.
|
||
MODE is redundant except when X is a CONST_INT (since they don't
|
||
carry mode info).
|
||
SIZE is an rtx for the size of data to be copied (in bytes),
|
||
needed only if X is BLKmode.
|
||
|
||
ALIGN (in bits) is maximum alignment we can assume.
|
||
|
||
If PARTIAL and REG are both nonzero, then copy that many of the first
|
||
bytes of X into registers starting with REG, and push the rest of X.
|
||
The amount of space pushed is decreased by PARTIAL bytes.
|
||
REG must be a hard register in this case.
|
||
If REG is zero but PARTIAL is not, take any all others actions for an
|
||
argument partially in registers, but do not actually load any
|
||
registers.
|
||
|
||
EXTRA is the amount in bytes of extra space to leave next to this arg.
|
||
This is ignored if an argument block has already been allocated.
|
||
|
||
On a machine that lacks real push insns, ARGS_ADDR is the address of
|
||
the bottom of the argument block for this call. We use indexing off there
|
||
to store the arg. On machines with push insns, ARGS_ADDR is 0 when a
|
||
argument block has not been preallocated.
|
||
|
||
ARGS_SO_FAR is the size of args previously pushed for this call.
|
||
|
||
REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE is nonzero if functions require stack space
|
||
for arguments passed in registers. If nonzero, it will be the number
|
||
of bytes required. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
emit_push_insn (rtx x, enum machine_mode mode, tree type, rtx size,
|
||
unsigned int align, int partial, rtx reg, int extra,
|
||
rtx args_addr, rtx args_so_far, int reg_parm_stack_space,
|
||
rtx alignment_pad)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx xinner;
|
||
enum direction stack_direction
|
||
#ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
|
||
= downward;
|
||
#else
|
||
= upward;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Decide where to pad the argument: `downward' for below,
|
||
`upward' for above, or `none' for don't pad it.
|
||
Default is below for small data on big-endian machines; else above. */
|
||
enum direction where_pad = FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (mode, type);
|
||
|
||
/* Invert direction if stack is post-decrement.
|
||
FIXME: why? */
|
||
if (STACK_PUSH_CODE == POST_DEC)
|
||
if (where_pad != none)
|
||
where_pad = (where_pad == downward ? upward : downward);
|
||
|
||
xinner = x;
|
||
|
||
if (mode == BLKmode)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Copy a block into the stack, entirely or partially. */
|
||
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
int used;
|
||
int offset;
|
||
int skip;
|
||
|
||
offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
used = partial - offset;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (size);
|
||
|
||
/* USED is now the # of bytes we need not copy to the stack
|
||
because registers will take care of them. */
|
||
|
||
if (partial != 0)
|
||
xinner = adjust_address (xinner, BLKmode, used);
|
||
|
||
/* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
|
||
skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
|
||
Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
|
||
by setting SKIP to 0. */
|
||
skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : used;
|
||
|
||
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
|
||
/* Do it with several push insns if that doesn't take lots of insns
|
||
and if there is no difficulty with push insns that skip bytes
|
||
on the stack for alignment purposes. */
|
||
if (args_addr == 0
|
||
&& PUSH_ARGS
|
||
&& GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& skip == 0
|
||
&& MEM_ALIGN (xinner) >= align
|
||
&& (MOVE_BY_PIECES_P ((unsigned) INTVAL (size) - used, align))
|
||
/* Here we avoid the case of a structure whose weak alignment
|
||
forces many pushes of a small amount of data,
|
||
and such small pushes do rounding that causes trouble. */
|
||
&& ((! SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (word_mode, align))
|
||
|| align >= BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
|
||
|| (PUSH_ROUNDING (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
||
== (align / BITS_PER_UNIT)))
|
||
&& PUSH_ROUNDING (INTVAL (size)) == INTVAL (size))
|
||
{
|
||
/* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
|
||
or if padding below and stack grows up.
|
||
But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
|
||
if (extra && args_addr == 0
|
||
&& where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
|
||
anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
|
||
|
||
move_by_pieces (NULL, xinner, INTVAL (size) - used, align, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
#endif /* PUSH_ROUNDING */
|
||
{
|
||
rtx target;
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise make space on the stack and copy the data
|
||
to the address of that space. */
|
||
|
||
/* Deduct words put into registers from the size we must copy. */
|
||
if (partial != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT)
|
||
size = GEN_INT (INTVAL (size) - used);
|
||
else
|
||
size = expand_binop (GET_MODE (size), sub_optab, size,
|
||
GEN_INT (used), NULL_RTX, 0,
|
||
OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Get the address of the stack space.
|
||
In this case, we do not deal with EXTRA separately.
|
||
A single stack adjust will do. */
|
||
if (! args_addr)
|
||
{
|
||
temp = push_block (size, extra, where_pad == downward);
|
||
extra = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (args_so_far) == CONST_INT)
|
||
temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
|
||
plus_constant (args_addr,
|
||
skip + INTVAL (args_so_far)));
|
||
else
|
||
temp = memory_address (BLKmode,
|
||
plus_constant (gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
||
args_addr,
|
||
args_so_far),
|
||
skip));
|
||
|
||
if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
|
||
{
|
||
/* If the source is referenced relative to the stack pointer,
|
||
copy it to another register to stabilize it. We do not need
|
||
to do this if we know that we won't be changing sp. */
|
||
|
||
if (reg_mentioned_p (virtual_stack_dynamic_rtx, temp)
|
||
|| reg_mentioned_p (virtual_outgoing_args_rtx, temp))
|
||
temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
target = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, temp);
|
||
|
||
/* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
|
||
may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
|
||
allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
|
||
to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
|
||
to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
|
||
/* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
|
||
PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
|
||
set_mem_align (target, align);
|
||
|
||
emit_block_move (target, xinner, size, BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (partial > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Scalar partly in registers. */
|
||
|
||
int size = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
int i;
|
||
int not_stack;
|
||
/* # bytes of start of argument
|
||
that we must make space for but need not store. */
|
||
int offset = partial % (PARM_BOUNDARY / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
int args_offset = INTVAL (args_so_far);
|
||
int skip;
|
||
|
||
/* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
|
||
or if padding below and stack grows up.
|
||
But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
|
||
if (extra && args_addr == 0
|
||
&& where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
|
||
anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
|
||
|
||
/* If we make space by pushing it, we might as well push
|
||
the real data. Otherwise, we can leave OFFSET nonzero
|
||
and leave the space uninitialized. */
|
||
if (args_addr == 0)
|
||
offset = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Now NOT_STACK gets the number of words that we don't need to
|
||
allocate on the stack. Convert OFFSET to words too. */
|
||
not_stack = (partial - offset) / UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
offset /= UNITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
|
||
/* If the partial register-part of the arg counts in its stack size,
|
||
skip the part of stack space corresponding to the registers.
|
||
Otherwise, start copying to the beginning of the stack space,
|
||
by setting SKIP to 0. */
|
||
skip = (reg_parm_stack_space == 0) ? 0 : not_stack;
|
||
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (x) && ! LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (x))
|
||
x = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, x));
|
||
|
||
/* If X is a hard register in a non-integer mode, copy it into a pseudo;
|
||
SUBREGs of such registers are not allowed. */
|
||
if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (x)) != MODE_INT))
|
||
x = copy_to_reg (x);
|
||
|
||
/* Loop over all the words allocated on the stack for this arg. */
|
||
/* We can do it by words, because any scalar bigger than a word
|
||
has a size a multiple of a word. */
|
||
#ifndef PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
|
||
for (i = not_stack; i < size; i++)
|
||
#else
|
||
for (i = size - 1; i >= not_stack; i--)
|
||
#endif
|
||
if (i >= not_stack + offset)
|
||
emit_push_insn (operand_subword_force (x, i, mode),
|
||
word_mode, NULL_TREE, NULL_RTX, align, 0, NULL_RTX,
|
||
0, args_addr,
|
||
GEN_INT (args_offset + ((i - not_stack + skip)
|
||
* UNITS_PER_WORD)),
|
||
reg_parm_stack_space, alignment_pad);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
rtx addr;
|
||
rtx dest;
|
||
|
||
/* Push padding now if padding above and stack grows down,
|
||
or if padding below and stack grows up.
|
||
But if space already allocated, this has already been done. */
|
||
if (extra && args_addr == 0
|
||
&& where_pad != none && where_pad != stack_direction)
|
||
anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
|
||
|
||
#ifdef PUSH_ROUNDING
|
||
if (args_addr == 0 && PUSH_ARGS)
|
||
emit_single_push_insn (mode, x, type);
|
||
else
|
||
#endif
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (args_so_far) == CONST_INT)
|
||
addr
|
||
= memory_address (mode,
|
||
plus_constant (args_addr,
|
||
INTVAL (args_so_far)));
|
||
else
|
||
addr = memory_address (mode, gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode, args_addr,
|
||
args_so_far));
|
||
dest = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, addr);
|
||
|
||
/* We do *not* set_mem_attributes here, because incoming arguments
|
||
may overlap with sibling call outgoing arguments and we cannot
|
||
allow reordering of reads from function arguments with stores
|
||
to outgoing arguments of sibling calls. We do, however, want
|
||
to record the alignment of the stack slot. */
|
||
/* ALIGN may well be better aligned than TYPE, e.g. due to
|
||
PARM_BOUNDARY. Assume the caller isn't lying. */
|
||
set_mem_align (dest, align);
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (dest, x);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If part should go in registers, copy that part
|
||
into the appropriate registers. Do this now, at the end,
|
||
since mem-to-mem copies above may do function calls. */
|
||
if (partial > 0 && reg != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
|
||
The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (reg) == PARALLEL)
|
||
emit_group_load (reg, x, type, -1);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (partial % UNITS_PER_WORD == 0);
|
||
move_block_to_reg (REGNO (reg), x, partial / UNITS_PER_WORD, mode);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (extra && args_addr == 0 && where_pad == stack_direction)
|
||
anti_adjust_stack (GEN_INT (extra));
|
||
|
||
if (alignment_pad && args_addr == 0)
|
||
anti_adjust_stack (alignment_pad);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return X if X can be used as a subtarget in a sequence of arithmetic
|
||
operations. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
get_subtarget (rtx x)
|
||
{
|
||
return (optimize
|
||
|| x == 0
|
||
/* Only registers can be subtargets. */
|
||
|| !REG_P (x)
|
||
/* Don't use hard regs to avoid extending their life. */
|
||
|| REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
|
||
? 0 : x);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of expand_assignment. Optimize FIELD op= VAL, where
|
||
FIELD is a bitfield. Returns true if the optimization was successful,
|
||
and there's nothing else to do. */
|
||
|
||
static bool
|
||
optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
|
||
enum machine_mode mode1, rtx str_rtx,
|
||
tree to, tree src)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode str_mode = GET_MODE (str_rtx);
|
||
unsigned int str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
|
||
tree op0, op1;
|
||
rtx value, result;
|
||
optab binop;
|
||
|
||
if (mode1 != VOIDmode
|
||
|| bitsize >= BITS_PER_WORD
|
||
|| str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD
|
||
|| TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (to)
|
||
|| TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (to))
|
||
return false;
|
||
|
||
STRIP_NOPS (src);
|
||
if (!BINARY_CLASS_P (src)
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (src)) != INTEGER_TYPE)
|
||
return false;
|
||
|
||
op0 = TREE_OPERAND (src, 0);
|
||
op1 = TREE_OPERAND (src, 1);
|
||
STRIP_NOPS (op0);
|
||
|
||
if (!operand_equal_p (to, op0, 0))
|
||
return false;
|
||
|
||
if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset1;
|
||
|
||
if (str_bitsize == 0 || str_bitsize > BITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
str_mode = word_mode;
|
||
str_mode = get_best_mode (bitsize, bitpos,
|
||
MEM_ALIGN (str_rtx), str_mode, 0);
|
||
if (str_mode == VOIDmode)
|
||
return false;
|
||
str_bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (str_mode);
|
||
|
||
offset1 = bitpos;
|
||
bitpos %= str_bitsize;
|
||
offset1 = (offset1 - bitpos) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
|
||
str_rtx = adjust_address (str_rtx, str_mode, offset1);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (!REG_P (str_rtx) && GET_CODE (str_rtx) != SUBREG)
|
||
return false;
|
||
|
||
/* If the bit field covers the whole REG/MEM, store_field
|
||
will likely generate better code. */
|
||
if (bitsize >= str_bitsize)
|
||
return false;
|
||
|
||
/* We can't handle fields split across multiple entities. */
|
||
if (bitpos + bitsize > str_bitsize)
|
||
return false;
|
||
|
||
if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
||
bitpos = str_bitsize - bitpos - bitsize;
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (src))
|
||
{
|
||
case PLUS_EXPR:
|
||
case MINUS_EXPR:
|
||
/* For now, just optimize the case of the topmost bitfield
|
||
where we don't need to do any masking and also
|
||
1 bit bitfields where xor can be used.
|
||
We might win by one instruction for the other bitfields
|
||
too if insv/extv instructions aren't used, so that
|
||
can be added later. */
|
||
if (bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize
|
||
&& (bitsize != 1 || TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST))
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, str_mode, 0);
|
||
value = convert_modes (str_mode,
|
||
TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
|
||
|
||
/* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
|
||
we can alias adjacent data. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
|
||
{
|
||
str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
|
||
set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
|
||
set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
binop = TREE_CODE (src) == PLUS_EXPR ? add_optab : sub_optab;
|
||
if (bitsize == 1 && bitpos + bitsize != str_bitsize)
|
||
{
|
||
value = expand_and (str_mode, value, const1_rtx, NULL);
|
||
binop = xor_optab;
|
||
}
|
||
value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, str_mode, value,
|
||
build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, bitpos),
|
||
NULL_RTX, 1);
|
||
result = expand_binop (str_mode, binop, str_rtx,
|
||
value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
|
||
if (result != str_rtx)
|
||
emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
|
||
return true;
|
||
|
||
case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
|
||
case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (op1) != INTEGER_CST)
|
||
break;
|
||
value = expand_expr (op1, NULL_RTX, GET_MODE (str_rtx), 0);
|
||
value = convert_modes (GET_MODE (str_rtx),
|
||
TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (op1)), value,
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (op1)));
|
||
|
||
/* We may be accessing data outside the field, which means
|
||
we can alias adjacent data. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (str_rtx))
|
||
{
|
||
str_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (str_rtx);
|
||
set_mem_alias_set (str_rtx, 0);
|
||
set_mem_expr (str_rtx, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
binop = TREE_CODE (src) == BIT_IOR_EXPR ? ior_optab : xor_optab;
|
||
if (bitpos + bitsize != GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (str_rtx)))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx mask = GEN_INT (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize)
|
||
- 1);
|
||
value = expand_and (GET_MODE (str_rtx), value, mask,
|
||
NULL_RTX);
|
||
}
|
||
value = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (str_rtx), value,
|
||
build_int_cst (NULL_TREE, bitpos),
|
||
NULL_RTX, 1);
|
||
result = expand_binop (GET_MODE (str_rtx), binop, str_rtx,
|
||
value, str_rtx, 1, OPTAB_WIDEN);
|
||
if (result != str_rtx)
|
||
emit_move_insn (str_rtx, result);
|
||
return true;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return false;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Expand an assignment that stores the value of FROM into TO. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
expand_assignment (tree to, tree from)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx to_rtx = 0;
|
||
rtx result;
|
||
|
||
/* Don't crash if the lhs of the assignment was erroneous. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (to) == ERROR_MARK)
|
||
{
|
||
result = expand_normal (from);
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Optimize away no-op moves without side-effects. */
|
||
if (operand_equal_p (to, from, 0))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
/* Assignment of a structure component needs special treatment
|
||
if the structure component's rtx is not simply a MEM.
|
||
Assignment of an array element at a constant index, and assignment of
|
||
an array element in an unaligned packed structure field, has the same
|
||
problem. */
|
||
if (handled_component_p (to)
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (to)) == ARRAY_TYPE)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode1;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
|
||
tree offset;
|
||
int unsignedp;
|
||
int volatilep = 0;
|
||
tree tem;
|
||
|
||
push_temp_slots ();
|
||
tem = get_inner_reference (to, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode1,
|
||
&unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
|
||
|
||
/* If we are going to use store_bit_field and extract_bit_field,
|
||
make sure to_rtx will be safe for multiple use. */
|
||
|
||
to_rtx = expand_normal (tem);
|
||
|
||
if (offset != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx offset_rtx;
|
||
|
||
if (!MEM_P (to_rtx))
|
||
{
|
||
/* We can get constant negative offsets into arrays with broken
|
||
user code. Translate this to a trap instead of ICEing. */
|
||
gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (offset) == INTEGER_CST);
|
||
expand_builtin_trap ();
|
||
to_rtx = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, const0_rtx);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
|
||
#ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
||
if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != Pmode)
|
||
offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, offset_rtx, 0);
|
||
#else
|
||
if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
|
||
offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* A constant address in TO_RTX can have VOIDmode, we must not try
|
||
to call force_reg for that case. Avoid that case. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (to_rtx)
|
||
&& GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode
|
||
&& GET_MODE (XEXP (to_rtx, 0)) != VOIDmode
|
||
&& bitsize > 0
|
||
&& (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
|
||
&& (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
|
||
&& MEM_ALIGN (to_rtx) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
|
||
{
|
||
to_rtx = adjust_address (to_rtx, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
bitpos = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
|
||
highest_pow2_factor_for_target (to,
|
||
offset));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Handle expand_expr of a complex value returning a CONCAT. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (from)) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (bitpos == 0);
|
||
result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, false);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (bitpos == 0 || bitpos == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode1));
|
||
result = store_expr (from, XEXP (to_rtx, bitpos != 0), false);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (MEM_P (to_rtx))
|
||
{
|
||
/* If the field is at offset zero, we could have been given the
|
||
DECL_RTX of the parent struct. Don't munge it. */
|
||
to_rtx = shallow_copy_rtx (to_rtx);
|
||
|
||
set_mem_attributes_minus_bitpos (to_rtx, to, 0, bitpos);
|
||
|
||
/* Deal with volatile and readonly fields. The former is only
|
||
done for MEM. Also set MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P if needed. */
|
||
if (volatilep)
|
||
MEM_VOLATILE_P (to_rtx) = 1;
|
||
if (component_uses_parent_alias_set (to))
|
||
MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (optimize_bitfield_assignment_op (bitsize, bitpos, mode1,
|
||
to_rtx, to, from))
|
||
result = NULL;
|
||
else
|
||
result = store_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode1, from,
|
||
TREE_TYPE (tem), get_alias_set (to));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (result)
|
||
preserve_temp_slots (result);
|
||
free_temp_slots ();
|
||
pop_temp_slots ();
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the rhs is a function call and its value is not an aggregate,
|
||
call the function before we start to compute the lhs.
|
||
This is needed for correct code for cases such as
|
||
val = setjmp (buf) on machines where reference to val
|
||
requires loading up part of an address in a separate insn.
|
||
|
||
Don't do this if TO is a VAR_DECL or PARM_DECL whose DECL_RTL is REG
|
||
since it might be a promoted variable where the zero- or sign- extension
|
||
needs to be done. Handling this in the normal way is safe because no
|
||
computation is done before the call. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (from) == CALL_EXPR && ! aggregate_value_p (from, from)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (from))) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& ! ((TREE_CODE (to) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (to) == PARM_DECL)
|
||
&& REG_P (DECL_RTL (to))))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx value;
|
||
|
||
push_temp_slots ();
|
||
value = expand_normal (from);
|
||
if (to_rtx == 0)
|
||
to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
|
||
|
||
/* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
|
||
The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
|
||
emit_group_load (to_rtx, value, TREE_TYPE (from),
|
||
int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
|
||
else if (GET_MODE (to_rtx) == BLKmode)
|
||
emit_block_move (to_rtx, value, expr_size (from), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (POINTER_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (to)))
|
||
value = convert_memory_address (GET_MODE (to_rtx), value);
|
||
emit_move_insn (to_rtx, value);
|
||
}
|
||
preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
|
||
free_temp_slots ();
|
||
pop_temp_slots ();
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Ordinary treatment. Expand TO to get a REG or MEM rtx.
|
||
Don't re-expand if it was expanded already (in COMPONENT_REF case). */
|
||
|
||
if (to_rtx == 0)
|
||
to_rtx = expand_expr (to, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_WRITE);
|
||
|
||
/* Don't move directly into a return register. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL
|
||
&& (REG_P (to_rtx) || GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
|
||
push_temp_slots ();
|
||
temp = expand_expr (from, 0, GET_MODE (to_rtx), 0);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (to_rtx) == PARALLEL)
|
||
emit_group_load (to_rtx, temp, TREE_TYPE (from),
|
||
int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (from)));
|
||
else
|
||
emit_move_insn (to_rtx, temp);
|
||
|
||
preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
|
||
free_temp_slots ();
|
||
pop_temp_slots ();
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* In case we are returning the contents of an object which overlaps
|
||
the place the value is being stored, use a safe function when copying
|
||
a value through a pointer into a structure value return block. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (to) == RESULT_DECL && TREE_CODE (from) == INDIRECT_REF
|
||
&& current_function_returns_struct
|
||
&& !current_function_returns_pcc_struct)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx from_rtx, size;
|
||
|
||
push_temp_slots ();
|
||
size = expr_size (from);
|
||
from_rtx = expand_normal (from);
|
||
|
||
emit_library_call (memmove_libfunc, LCT_NORMAL,
|
||
VOIDmode, 3, XEXP (to_rtx, 0), Pmode,
|
||
XEXP (from_rtx, 0), Pmode,
|
||
convert_to_mode (TYPE_MODE (sizetype),
|
||
size, TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype)),
|
||
TYPE_MODE (sizetype));
|
||
|
||
preserve_temp_slots (to_rtx);
|
||
free_temp_slots ();
|
||
pop_temp_slots ();
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Compute FROM and store the value in the rtx we got. */
|
||
|
||
push_temp_slots ();
|
||
result = store_expr (from, to_rtx, 0);
|
||
preserve_temp_slots (result);
|
||
free_temp_slots ();
|
||
pop_temp_slots ();
|
||
return;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate code for computing expression EXP,
|
||
and storing the value into TARGET.
|
||
|
||
If the mode is BLKmode then we may return TARGET itself.
|
||
It turns out that in BLKmode it doesn't cause a problem.
|
||
because C has no operators that could combine two different
|
||
assignments into the same BLKmode object with different values
|
||
with no sequence point. Will other languages need this to
|
||
be more thorough?
|
||
|
||
If CALL_PARAM_P is nonzero, this is a store into a call param on the
|
||
stack, and block moves may need to be treated specially. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
store_expr (tree exp, rtx target, int call_param_p)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
rtx alt_rtl = NULL_RTX;
|
||
int dont_return_target = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* C++ can generate ?: expressions with a throw expression in one
|
||
branch and an rvalue in the other. Here, we resolve attempts to
|
||
store the throw expression's nonexistent result. */
|
||
gcc_assert (!call_param_p);
|
||
expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
return NULL_RTX;
|
||
}
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPOUND_EXPR)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Perform first part of compound expression, then assign from second
|
||
part. */
|
||
expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
|
||
call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
return store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COND_EXPR && GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
|
||
{
|
||
/* For conditional expression, get safe form of the target. Then
|
||
test the condition, doing the appropriate assignment on either
|
||
side. This avoids the creation of unnecessary temporaries.
|
||
For non-BLKmode, it is more efficient not to do this. */
|
||
|
||
rtx lab1 = gen_label_rtx (), lab2 = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
|
||
do_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
||
NO_DEFER_POP;
|
||
jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), lab1);
|
||
store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target, call_param_p);
|
||
emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (lab2));
|
||
emit_barrier ();
|
||
emit_label (lab1);
|
||
store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), target, call_param_p);
|
||
emit_label (lab2);
|
||
OK_DEFER_POP;
|
||
|
||
return NULL_RTX;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG && SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (target))
|
||
/* If this is a scalar in a register that is stored in a wider mode
|
||
than the declared mode, compute the result into its declared mode
|
||
and then convert to the wider mode. Our value is the computed
|
||
expression. */
|
||
{
|
||
rtx inner_target = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* We can do the conversion inside EXP, which will often result
|
||
in some optimizations. Do the conversion in two steps: first
|
||
change the signedness, if needed, then the extend. But don't
|
||
do this if the type of EXP is a subtype of something else
|
||
since then the conversion might involve more than just
|
||
converting modes. */
|
||
if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
|
||
&& TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == 0
|
||
&& (!lang_hooks.reduce_bit_field_operations
|
||
|| (GET_MODE_PRECISION (GET_MODE (target))
|
||
== TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (exp)))))
|
||
{
|
||
if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp))
|
||
!= SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target))
|
||
exp = fold_convert
|
||
(lang_hooks.types.signed_or_unsigned_type
|
||
(SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target), TREE_TYPE (exp)), exp);
|
||
|
||
exp = fold_convert (lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode
|
||
(GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
|
||
SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target)),
|
||
exp);
|
||
|
||
inner_target = SUBREG_REG (target);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
temp = expand_expr (exp, inner_target, VOIDmode,
|
||
call_param_p ? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
|
||
/* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant, use convert_modes to make
|
||
sure that we properly convert it. */
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode)
|
||
{
|
||
temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
|
||
temp, SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
|
||
temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (target)),
|
||
GET_MODE (target), temp,
|
||
SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
convert_move (SUBREG_REG (target), temp,
|
||
SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_P (target));
|
||
|
||
return NULL_RTX;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
temp = expand_expr_real (exp, target, GET_MODE (target),
|
||
(call_param_p
|
||
? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL),
|
||
&alt_rtl);
|
||
/* Return TARGET if it's a specified hardware register.
|
||
If TARGET is a volatile mem ref, either return TARGET
|
||
or return a reg copied *from* TARGET; ANSI requires this.
|
||
|
||
Otherwise, if TEMP is not TARGET, return TEMP
|
||
if it is constant (for efficiency),
|
||
or if we really want the correct value. */
|
||
if (!(target && REG_P (target)
|
||
&& REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
&& !(MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
|
||
&& ! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
|
||
&& CONSTANT_P (temp))
|
||
dont_return_target = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If TEMP is a VOIDmode constant and the mode of the type of EXP is not
|
||
the same as that of TARGET, adjust the constant. This is needed, for
|
||
example, in case it is a CONST_DOUBLE and we want only a word-sized
|
||
value. */
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (temp) && GET_MODE (temp) == VOIDmode
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
|
||
&& GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
|
||
temp = convert_modes (GET_MODE (target), TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
|
||
temp, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
|
||
|
||
/* If value was not generated in the target, store it there.
|
||
Convert the value to TARGET's type first if necessary and emit the
|
||
pending incrementations that have been queued when expanding EXP.
|
||
Note that we cannot emit the whole queue blindly because this will
|
||
effectively disable the POST_INC optimization later.
|
||
|
||
If TEMP and TARGET compare equal according to rtx_equal_p, but
|
||
one or both of them are volatile memory refs, we have to distinguish
|
||
two cases:
|
||
- expand_expr has used TARGET. In this case, we must not generate
|
||
another copy. This can be detected by TARGET being equal according
|
||
to == .
|
||
- expand_expr has not used TARGET - that means that the source just
|
||
happens to have the same RTX form. Since temp will have been created
|
||
by expand_expr, it will compare unequal according to == .
|
||
We must generate a copy in this case, to reach the correct number
|
||
of volatile memory references. */
|
||
|
||
if ((! rtx_equal_p (temp, target)
|
||
|| (temp != target && (side_effects_p (temp)
|
||
|| side_effects_p (target))))
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (exp) != ERROR_MARK
|
||
/* If store_expr stores a DECL whose DECL_RTL(exp) == TARGET,
|
||
but TARGET is not valid memory reference, TEMP will differ
|
||
from TARGET although it is really the same location. */
|
||
&& !(alt_rtl && rtx_equal_p (alt_rtl, target))
|
||
/* If there's nothing to copy, don't bother. Don't call
|
||
expr_size unless necessary, because some front-ends (C++)
|
||
expr_size-hook must not be given objects that are not
|
||
supposed to be bit-copied or bit-initialized. */
|
||
&& expr_size (exp) != const0_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_MODE (temp) != GET_MODE (target)
|
||
&& GET_MODE (temp) != VOIDmode)
|
||
{
|
||
int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
|
||
if (dont_return_target)
|
||
{
|
||
/* In this case, we will return TEMP,
|
||
so make sure it has the proper mode.
|
||
But don't forget to store the value into TARGET. */
|
||
temp = convert_to_mode (GET_MODE (target), temp, unsignedp);
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, temp);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode)
|
||
emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
|
||
(call_param_p
|
||
? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM
|
||
: BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
|
||
else
|
||
convert_move (target, temp, unsignedp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode && TREE_CODE (exp) == STRING_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Handle copying a string constant into an array. The string
|
||
constant may be shorter than the array. So copy just the string's
|
||
actual length, and clear the rest. First get the size of the data
|
||
type of the string, which is actually the size of the target. */
|
||
rtx size = expr_size (exp);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (size) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& INTVAL (size) < TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp))
|
||
emit_block_move (target, temp, size,
|
||
(call_param_p
|
||
? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Compute the size of the data to copy from the string. */
|
||
tree copy_size
|
||
= size_binop (MIN_EXPR,
|
||
make_tree (sizetype, size),
|
||
size_int (TREE_STRING_LENGTH (exp)));
|
||
rtx copy_size_rtx
|
||
= expand_expr (copy_size, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
|
||
(call_param_p
|
||
? EXPAND_STACK_PARM : EXPAND_NORMAL));
|
||
rtx label = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Copy that much. */
|
||
copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, copy_size_rtx,
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
|
||
emit_block_move (target, temp, copy_size_rtx,
|
||
(call_param_p
|
||
? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
|
||
|
||
/* Figure out how much is left in TARGET that we have to clear.
|
||
Do all calculations in ptr_mode. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (copy_size_rtx) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
size = plus_constant (size, -INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
|
||
target = adjust_address (target, BLKmode,
|
||
INTVAL (copy_size_rtx));
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
size = expand_binop (TYPE_MODE (sizetype), sub_optab, size,
|
||
copy_size_rtx, NULL_RTX, 0,
|
||
OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
|
||
#ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
||
if (GET_MODE (copy_size_rtx) != Pmode)
|
||
copy_size_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, copy_size_rtx,
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (sizetype));
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
target = offset_address (target, copy_size_rtx,
|
||
highest_pow2_factor (copy_size));
|
||
label = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (size, const0_rtx, LT, NULL_RTX,
|
||
GET_MODE (size), 0, label);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (size != const0_rtx)
|
||
clear_storage (target, size, BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
|
||
|
||
if (label)
|
||
emit_label (label);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
/* Handle calls that return values in multiple non-contiguous locations.
|
||
The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
|
||
else if (GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL)
|
||
emit_group_load (target, temp, TREE_TYPE (exp),
|
||
int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
|
||
else if (GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
|
||
emit_block_move (target, temp, expr_size (exp),
|
||
(call_param_p
|
||
? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
temp = force_operand (temp, target);
|
||
if (temp != target)
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, temp);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return NULL_RTX;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Helper for categorize_ctor_elements. Identical interface. */
|
||
|
||
static bool
|
||
categorize_ctor_elements_1 (tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT *p_elt_count,
|
||
bool *p_must_clear)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, elt_count;
|
||
tree value, purpose;
|
||
|
||
/* Whether CTOR is a valid constant initializer, in accordance with what
|
||
initializer_constant_valid_p does. If inferred from the constructor
|
||
elements, true until proven otherwise. */
|
||
bool const_from_elts_p = constructor_static_from_elts_p (ctor);
|
||
bool const_p = const_from_elts_p ? true : TREE_STATIC (ctor);
|
||
|
||
nz_elts = 0;
|
||
elt_count = 0;
|
||
|
||
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor), idx, purpose, value)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT mult;
|
||
|
||
mult = 1;
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (purpose) == RANGE_EXPR)
|
||
{
|
||
tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 0);
|
||
tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (purpose, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (host_integerp (lo_index, 1) && host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
|
||
mult = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
|
||
- tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (value))
|
||
{
|
||
case CONSTRUCTOR:
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT nz = 0, ic = 0;
|
||
|
||
bool const_elt_p
|
||
= categorize_ctor_elements_1 (value, &nz, &ic, p_must_clear);
|
||
|
||
nz_elts += mult * nz;
|
||
elt_count += mult * ic;
|
||
|
||
if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
|
||
const_p = const_elt_p;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case INTEGER_CST:
|
||
case REAL_CST:
|
||
if (!initializer_zerop (value))
|
||
nz_elts += mult;
|
||
elt_count += mult;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case STRING_CST:
|
||
nz_elts += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
|
||
elt_count += mult * TREE_STRING_LENGTH (value);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case COMPLEX_CST:
|
||
if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_REALPART (value)))
|
||
nz_elts += mult;
|
||
if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_IMAGPART (value)))
|
||
nz_elts += mult;
|
||
elt_count += mult;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case VECTOR_CST:
|
||
{
|
||
tree v;
|
||
for (v = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (value); v; v = TREE_CHAIN (v))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!initializer_zerop (TREE_VALUE (v)))
|
||
nz_elts += mult;
|
||
elt_count += mult;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
nz_elts += mult;
|
||
elt_count += mult;
|
||
|
||
if (const_from_elts_p && const_p)
|
||
const_p = initializer_constant_valid_p (value, TREE_TYPE (value))
|
||
!= NULL_TREE;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (!*p_must_clear
|
||
&& (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (ctor)) == UNION_TYPE
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (ctor)) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE))
|
||
{
|
||
tree init_sub_type;
|
||
bool clear_this = true;
|
||
|
||
if (!VEC_empty (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor)))
|
||
{
|
||
/* We don't expect more than one element of the union to be
|
||
initialized. Not sure what we should do otherwise... */
|
||
gcc_assert (VEC_length (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor))
|
||
== 1);
|
||
|
||
init_sub_type = TREE_TYPE (VEC_index (constructor_elt,
|
||
CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (ctor),
|
||
0)->value);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? We could look at each element of the union, and find the
|
||
largest element. Which would avoid comparing the size of the
|
||
initialized element against any tail padding in the union.
|
||
Doesn't seem worth the effort... */
|
||
if (simple_cst_equal (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (ctor)),
|
||
TYPE_SIZE (init_sub_type)) == 1)
|
||
{
|
||
/* And now we have to find out if the element itself is fully
|
||
constructed. E.g. for union { struct { int a, b; } s; } u
|
||
= { .s = { .a = 1 } }. */
|
||
if (elt_count == count_type_elements (init_sub_type, false))
|
||
clear_this = false;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
*p_must_clear = clear_this;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
*p_nz_elts += nz_elts;
|
||
*p_elt_count += elt_count;
|
||
|
||
return const_p;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Examine CTOR to discover:
|
||
* how many scalar fields are set to nonzero values,
|
||
and place it in *P_NZ_ELTS;
|
||
* how many scalar fields in total are in CTOR,
|
||
and place it in *P_ELT_COUNT.
|
||
* if a type is a union, and the initializer from the constructor
|
||
is not the largest element in the union, then set *p_must_clear.
|
||
|
||
Return whether or not CTOR is a valid static constant initializer, the same
|
||
as "initializer_constant_valid_p (CTOR, TREE_TYPE (CTOR)) != 0". */
|
||
|
||
bool
|
||
categorize_ctor_elements (tree ctor, HOST_WIDE_INT *p_nz_elts,
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT *p_elt_count,
|
||
bool *p_must_clear)
|
||
{
|
||
*p_nz_elts = 0;
|
||
*p_elt_count = 0;
|
||
*p_must_clear = false;
|
||
|
||
return
|
||
categorize_ctor_elements_1 (ctor, p_nz_elts, p_elt_count, p_must_clear);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Count the number of scalars in TYPE. Return -1 on overflow or
|
||
variable-sized. If ALLOW_FLEXARR is true, don't count flexible
|
||
array member at the end of the structure. */
|
||
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT
|
||
count_type_elements (tree type, bool allow_flexarr)
|
||
{
|
||
const HOST_WIDE_INT max = ~((HOST_WIDE_INT)1 << (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT-1));
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (type))
|
||
{
|
||
case ARRAY_TYPE:
|
||
{
|
||
tree telts = array_type_nelts (type);
|
||
if (telts && host_integerp (telts, 1))
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT n = tree_low_cst (telts, 1) + 1;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT m = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (type), false);
|
||
if (n == 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
else if (max / n > m)
|
||
return n * m;
|
||
}
|
||
return -1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case RECORD_TYPE:
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT n = 0, t;
|
||
tree f;
|
||
|
||
for (f = TYPE_FIELDS (type); f ; f = TREE_CHAIN (f))
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (f) == FIELD_DECL)
|
||
{
|
||
t = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (f), false);
|
||
if (t < 0)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Check for structures with flexible array member. */
|
||
tree tf = TREE_TYPE (f);
|
||
if (allow_flexarr
|
||
&& TREE_CHAIN (f) == NULL
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (tf) == ARRAY_TYPE
|
||
&& TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)
|
||
&& TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
|
||
&& integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf)))
|
||
&& !TYPE_MAX_VALUE (TYPE_DOMAIN (tf))
|
||
&& int_size_in_bytes (type) >= 0)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
return -1;
|
||
}
|
||
n += t;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return n;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case UNION_TYPE:
|
||
case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
|
||
return -1;
|
||
|
||
case COMPLEX_TYPE:
|
||
return 2;
|
||
|
||
case VECTOR_TYPE:
|
||
return TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
|
||
|
||
case INTEGER_TYPE:
|
||
case REAL_TYPE:
|
||
case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
|
||
case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
|
||
case POINTER_TYPE:
|
||
case OFFSET_TYPE:
|
||
case REFERENCE_TYPE:
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
case VOID_TYPE:
|
||
case METHOD_TYPE:
|
||
case FUNCTION_TYPE:
|
||
case LANG_TYPE:
|
||
default:
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return 1 if EXP contains mostly (3/4) zeros. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
mostly_zeros_p (tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
|
||
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, count, elts;
|
||
bool must_clear;
|
||
|
||
categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &count, &must_clear);
|
||
if (must_clear)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
elts = count_type_elements (TREE_TYPE (exp), false);
|
||
|
||
return nz_elts < elts / 4;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return initializer_zerop (exp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return 1 if EXP contains all zeros. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
all_zeros_p (tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
|
||
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT nz_elts, count;
|
||
bool must_clear;
|
||
|
||
categorize_ctor_elements (exp, &nz_elts, &count, &must_clear);
|
||
return nz_elts == 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return initializer_zerop (exp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Helper function for store_constructor.
|
||
TARGET, BITSIZE, BITPOS, MODE, EXP are as for store_field.
|
||
TYPE is the type of the CONSTRUCTOR, not the element type.
|
||
CLEARED is as for store_constructor.
|
||
ALIAS_SET is the alias set to use for any stores.
|
||
|
||
This provides a recursive shortcut back to store_constructor when it isn't
|
||
necessary to go through store_field. This is so that we can pass through
|
||
the cleared field to let store_constructor know that we may not have to
|
||
clear a substructure if the outer structure has already been cleared. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
store_constructor_field (rtx target, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize,
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos, enum machine_mode mode,
|
||
tree exp, tree type, int cleared, int alias_set)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
|
||
/* We can only call store_constructor recursively if the size and
|
||
bit position are on a byte boundary. */
|
||
&& bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0
|
||
&& (bitsize > 0 && bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0)
|
||
/* If we have a nonzero bitpos for a register target, then we just
|
||
let store_field do the bitfield handling. This is unlikely to
|
||
generate unnecessary clear instructions anyways. */
|
||
&& (bitpos == 0 || MEM_P (target)))
|
||
{
|
||
if (MEM_P (target))
|
||
target
|
||
= adjust_address (target,
|
||
GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode
|
||
|| 0 != (bitpos
|
||
% GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (GET_MODE (target)))
|
||
? BLKmode : VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Update the alias set, if required. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (target) && ! MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
|
||
&& MEM_ALIAS_SET (target) != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
target = copy_rtx (target);
|
||
set_mem_alias_set (target, alias_set);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
store_constructor (exp, target, cleared, bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
store_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, type, alias_set);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Store the value of constructor EXP into the rtx TARGET.
|
||
TARGET is either a REG or a MEM; we know it cannot conflict, since
|
||
safe_from_p has been called.
|
||
CLEARED is true if TARGET is known to have been zero'd.
|
||
SIZE is the number of bytes of TARGET we are allowed to modify: this
|
||
may not be the same as the size of EXP if we are assigning to a field
|
||
which has been packed to exclude padding bits. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
store_constructor (tree exp, rtx target, int cleared, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
|
||
{
|
||
tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
|
||
#ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT exp_size = int_size_in_bytes (type);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (type))
|
||
{
|
||
case RECORD_TYPE:
|
||
case UNION_TYPE:
|
||
case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
|
||
tree field, value;
|
||
|
||
/* If size is zero or the target is already cleared, do nothing. */
|
||
if (size == 0 || cleared)
|
||
cleared = 1;
|
||
/* We either clear the aggregate or indicate the value is dead. */
|
||
else if ((TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (type) == QUAL_UNION_TYPE)
|
||
&& ! CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
|
||
/* If the constructor is empty, clear the union. */
|
||
{
|
||
clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
|
||
cleared = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we are building a static constructor into a register,
|
||
set the initial value as zero so we can fold the value into
|
||
a constant. But if more than one register is involved,
|
||
this probably loses. */
|
||
else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp)
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target)) <= UNITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
{
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
|
||
cleared = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the constructor has fewer fields than the structure or
|
||
if we are initializing the structure to mostly zeros, clear
|
||
the whole structure first. Don't do this if TARGET is a
|
||
register whose mode size isn't equal to SIZE since
|
||
clear_storage can't handle this case. */
|
||
else if (size > 0
|
||
&& (((int)VEC_length (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp))
|
||
!= fields_length (type))
|
||
|| mostly_zeros_p (exp))
|
||
&& (!REG_P (target)
|
||
|| ((HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (target))
|
||
== size)))
|
||
{
|
||
clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
|
||
cleared = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! cleared)
|
||
emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
|
||
|
||
/* Store each element of the constructor into the
|
||
corresponding field of TARGET. */
|
||
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, field, value)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos = 0;
|
||
tree offset;
|
||
rtx to_rtx = target;
|
||
|
||
/* Just ignore missing fields. We cleared the whole
|
||
structure, above, if any fields are missing. */
|
||
if (field == 0)
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (field), 1))
|
||
bitsize = tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (field), 1);
|
||
else
|
||
bitsize = -1;
|
||
|
||
mode = DECL_MODE (field);
|
||
if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
|
||
mode = VOIDmode;
|
||
|
||
offset = DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field);
|
||
if (host_integerp (offset, 0)
|
||
&& host_integerp (bit_position (field), 0))
|
||
{
|
||
bitpos = int_bit_position (field);
|
||
offset = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
bitpos = tree_low_cst (DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field), 0);
|
||
|
||
if (offset)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx offset_rtx;
|
||
|
||
offset
|
||
= SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (offset,
|
||
make_tree (TREE_TYPE (exp),
|
||
target));
|
||
|
||
offset_rtx = expand_normal (offset);
|
||
gcc_assert (MEM_P (to_rtx));
|
||
|
||
#ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
||
if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != Pmode)
|
||
offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, offset_rtx, 0);
|
||
#else
|
||
if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
|
||
offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
to_rtx = offset_address (to_rtx, offset_rtx,
|
||
highest_pow2_factor (offset));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#ifdef WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
|
||
/* If this initializes a field that is smaller than a
|
||
word, at the start of a word, try to widen it to a full
|
||
word. This special case allows us to output C++ member
|
||
function initializations in a form that the optimizers
|
||
can understand. */
|
||
if (REG_P (target)
|
||
&& bitsize < BITS_PER_WORD
|
||
&& bitpos % BITS_PER_WORD == 0
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (value) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& exp_size >= 0
|
||
&& bitpos + BITS_PER_WORD <= exp_size * BITS_PER_UNIT)
|
||
{
|
||
tree type = TREE_TYPE (value);
|
||
|
||
if (TYPE_PRECISION (type) < BITS_PER_WORD)
|
||
{
|
||
type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_size
|
||
(BITS_PER_WORD, TYPE_UNSIGNED (type));
|
||
value = fold_convert (type, value);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
|
||
value
|
||
= fold_build2 (LSHIFT_EXPR, type, value,
|
||
build_int_cst (type,
|
||
BITS_PER_WORD - bitsize));
|
||
bitsize = BITS_PER_WORD;
|
||
mode = word_mode;
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
if (MEM_P (to_rtx) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx)
|
||
&& DECL_NONADDRESSABLE_P (field))
|
||
{
|
||
to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
|
||
MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
store_constructor_field (to_rtx, bitsize, bitpos, mode,
|
||
value, type, cleared,
|
||
get_alias_set (TREE_TYPE (field)));
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
case ARRAY_TYPE:
|
||
{
|
||
tree value, index;
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT i;
|
||
int need_to_clear;
|
||
tree domain;
|
||
tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
|
||
int const_bounds_p;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT minelt = 0;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT maxelt = 0;
|
||
|
||
domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
|
||
const_bounds_p = (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)
|
||
&& TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain)
|
||
&& host_integerp (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0)
|
||
&& host_integerp (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0));
|
||
|
||
/* If we have constant bounds for the range of the type, get them. */
|
||
if (const_bounds_p)
|
||
{
|
||
minelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain), 0);
|
||
maxelt = tree_low_cst (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain), 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the constructor has fewer elements than the array, clear
|
||
the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
|
||
constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
|
||
if (cleared)
|
||
need_to_clear = 0;
|
||
else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
|
||
need_to_clear = 1;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
|
||
tree index, value;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
|
||
need_to_clear = ! const_bounds_p;
|
||
|
||
/* This loop is a more accurate version of the loop in
|
||
mostly_zeros_p (it handles RANGE_EXPR in an index). It
|
||
is also needed to check for missing elements. */
|
||
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, index, value)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT this_node_count;
|
||
|
||
if (need_to_clear)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
|
||
{
|
||
tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
|
||
tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (! host_integerp (lo_index, 1)
|
||
|| ! host_integerp (hi_index, 1))
|
||
{
|
||
need_to_clear = 1;
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
this_node_count = (tree_low_cst (hi_index, 1)
|
||
- tree_low_cst (lo_index, 1) + 1);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
this_node_count = 1;
|
||
|
||
count += this_node_count;
|
||
if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
|
||
zero_count += this_node_count;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the entire array first if there are any missing
|
||
elements, or if the incidence of zero elements is >=
|
||
75%. */
|
||
if (! need_to_clear
|
||
&& (count < maxelt - minelt + 1
|
||
|| 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count))
|
||
need_to_clear = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (need_to_clear && size > 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (REG_P (target))
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
|
||
else
|
||
clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
|
||
cleared = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (!cleared && REG_P (target))
|
||
/* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
|
||
emit_insn (gen_rtx_CLOBBER (VOIDmode, target));
|
||
|
||
/* Store each element of the constructor into the
|
||
corresponding element of TARGET, determined by counting the
|
||
elements. */
|
||
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), i, index, value)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
|
||
int unsignedp;
|
||
rtx xtarget = target;
|
||
|
||
if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (elttype);
|
||
mode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
|
||
if (mode == BLKmode)
|
||
bitsize = (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
|
||
? tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
|
||
: -1);
|
||
else
|
||
bitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
|
||
|
||
if (index != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (index) == RANGE_EXPR)
|
||
{
|
||
tree lo_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 0);
|
||
tree hi_index = TREE_OPERAND (index, 1);
|
||
rtx index_r, pos_rtx;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi, count;
|
||
tree position;
|
||
|
||
/* If the range is constant and "small", unroll the loop. */
|
||
if (const_bounds_p
|
||
&& host_integerp (lo_index, 0)
|
||
&& host_integerp (hi_index, 0)
|
||
&& (lo = tree_low_cst (lo_index, 0),
|
||
hi = tree_low_cst (hi_index, 0),
|
||
count = hi - lo + 1,
|
||
(!MEM_P (target)
|
||
|| count <= 2
|
||
|| (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1)
|
||
&& (tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1) * count
|
||
<= 40 * 8)))))
|
||
{
|
||
lo -= minelt; hi -= minelt;
|
||
for (; lo <= hi; lo++)
|
||
{
|
||
bitpos = lo * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0);
|
||
|
||
if (MEM_P (target)
|
||
&& !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
|
||
&& TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
|
||
{
|
||
target = copy_rtx (target);
|
||
MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
store_constructor_field
|
||
(target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value, type, cleared,
|
||
get_alias_set (elttype));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
rtx loop_start = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
rtx loop_end = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
tree exit_cond;
|
||
|
||
expand_normal (hi_index);
|
||
unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (domain);
|
||
|
||
index = build_decl (VAR_DECL, NULL_TREE, domain);
|
||
|
||
index_r
|
||
= gen_reg_rtx (promote_mode (domain, DECL_MODE (index),
|
||
&unsignedp, 0));
|
||
SET_DECL_RTL (index, index_r);
|
||
store_expr (lo_index, index_r, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Build the head of the loop. */
|
||
do_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
||
emit_label (loop_start);
|
||
|
||
/* Assign value to element index. */
|
||
position =
|
||
fold_convert (ssizetype,
|
||
fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
|
||
TREE_TYPE (index),
|
||
index,
|
||
TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
|
||
|
||
position =
|
||
size_binop (MULT_EXPR, position,
|
||
fold_convert (ssizetype,
|
||
TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
|
||
|
||
pos_rtx = expand_normal (position);
|
||
xtarget = offset_address (target, pos_rtx,
|
||
highest_pow2_factor (position));
|
||
xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (value) == CONSTRUCTOR)
|
||
store_constructor (value, xtarget, cleared,
|
||
bitsize / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
else
|
||
store_expr (value, xtarget, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Generate a conditional jump to exit the loop. */
|
||
exit_cond = build2 (LT_EXPR, integer_type_node,
|
||
index, hi_index);
|
||
jumpif (exit_cond, loop_end);
|
||
|
||
/* Update the loop counter, and jump to the head of
|
||
the loop. */
|
||
expand_assignment (index,
|
||
build2 (PLUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
|
||
index, integer_one_node));
|
||
|
||
emit_jump (loop_start);
|
||
|
||
/* Build the end of the loop. */
|
||
emit_label (loop_end);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if ((index != 0 && ! host_integerp (index, 0))
|
||
|| ! host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1))
|
||
{
|
||
tree position;
|
||
|
||
if (index == 0)
|
||
index = ssize_int (1);
|
||
|
||
if (minelt)
|
||
index = fold_convert (ssizetype,
|
||
fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR,
|
||
TREE_TYPE (index),
|
||
index,
|
||
TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain)));
|
||
|
||
position =
|
||
size_binop (MULT_EXPR, index,
|
||
fold_convert (ssizetype,
|
||
TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elttype)));
|
||
xtarget = offset_address (target,
|
||
expand_normal (position),
|
||
highest_pow2_factor (position));
|
||
xtarget = adjust_address (xtarget, mode, 0);
|
||
store_expr (value, xtarget, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (index != 0)
|
||
bitpos = ((tree_low_cst (index, 0) - minelt)
|
||
* tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
|
||
else
|
||
bitpos = (i * tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1));
|
||
|
||
if (MEM_P (target) && !MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE
|
||
&& TYPE_NONALIASED_COMPONENT (type))
|
||
{
|
||
target = copy_rtx (target);
|
||
MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (target) = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, value,
|
||
type, cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case VECTOR_TYPE:
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
|
||
constructor_elt *ce;
|
||
int i;
|
||
int need_to_clear;
|
||
int icode = 0;
|
||
tree elttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
|
||
int elt_size = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 1);
|
||
enum machine_mode eltmode = TYPE_MODE (elttype);
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos;
|
||
rtvec vector = NULL;
|
||
unsigned n_elts;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (eltmode != BLKmode);
|
||
|
||
n_elts = TYPE_VECTOR_SUBPARTS (type);
|
||
if (REG_P (target) && VECTOR_MODE_P (GET_MODE (target)))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (target);
|
||
|
||
icode = (int) vec_init_optab->handlers[mode].insn_code;
|
||
if (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned int i;
|
||
|
||
vector = rtvec_alloc (n_elts);
|
||
for (i = 0; i < n_elts; i++)
|
||
RTVEC_ELT (vector, i) = CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE_INNER (mode));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the constructor has fewer elements than the vector,
|
||
clear the whole array first. Similarly if this is static
|
||
constructor of a non-BLKmode object. */
|
||
if (cleared)
|
||
need_to_clear = 0;
|
||
else if (REG_P (target) && TREE_STATIC (exp))
|
||
need_to_clear = 1;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT count = 0, zero_count = 0;
|
||
tree value;
|
||
|
||
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
|
||
{
|
||
int n_elts_here = tree_low_cst
|
||
(int_const_binop (TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
|
||
TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)),
|
||
TYPE_SIZE (elttype), 0), 1);
|
||
|
||
count += n_elts_here;
|
||
if (mostly_zeros_p (value))
|
||
zero_count += n_elts_here;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Clear the entire vector first if there are any missing elements,
|
||
or if the incidence of zero elements is >= 75%. */
|
||
need_to_clear = (count < n_elts || 4 * zero_count >= 3 * count);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (need_to_clear && size > 0 && !vector)
|
||
{
|
||
if (REG_P (target))
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
|
||
else
|
||
clear_storage (target, GEN_INT (size), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
|
||
cleared = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Inform later passes that the old value is dead. */
|
||
if (!cleared && !vector && REG_P (target))
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, CONST0_RTX (GET_MODE (target)));
|
||
|
||
/* Store each element of the constructor into the corresponding
|
||
element of TARGET, determined by counting the elements. */
|
||
for (idx = 0, i = 0;
|
||
VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce);
|
||
idx++, i += bitsize / elt_size)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT eltpos;
|
||
tree value = ce->value;
|
||
|
||
bitsize = tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (value)), 1);
|
||
if (cleared && initializer_zerop (value))
|
||
continue;
|
||
|
||
if (ce->index)
|
||
eltpos = tree_low_cst (ce->index, 1);
|
||
else
|
||
eltpos = i;
|
||
|
||
if (vector)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Vector CONSTRUCTORs should only be built from smaller
|
||
vectors in the case of BLKmode vectors. */
|
||
gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) != VECTOR_TYPE);
|
||
RTVEC_ELT (vector, eltpos)
|
||
= expand_normal (value);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode value_mode =
|
||
TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (value)) == VECTOR_TYPE
|
||
? TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (value))
|
||
: eltmode;
|
||
bitpos = eltpos * elt_size;
|
||
store_constructor_field (target, bitsize, bitpos,
|
||
value_mode, value, type,
|
||
cleared, get_alias_set (elttype));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (vector)
|
||
emit_insn (GEN_FCN (icode)
|
||
(target,
|
||
gen_rtx_PARALLEL (GET_MODE (target), vector)));
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Store the value of EXP (an expression tree)
|
||
into a subfield of TARGET which has mode MODE and occupies
|
||
BITSIZE bits, starting BITPOS bits from the start of TARGET.
|
||
If MODE is VOIDmode, it means that we are storing into a bit-field.
|
||
|
||
Always return const0_rtx unless we have something particular to
|
||
return.
|
||
|
||
TYPE is the type of the underlying object,
|
||
|
||
ALIAS_SET is the alias set for the destination. This value will
|
||
(in general) be different from that for TARGET, since TARGET is a
|
||
reference to the containing structure. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
store_field (rtx target, HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos,
|
||
enum machine_mode mode, tree exp, tree type, int alias_set)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT width_mask = 0;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
/* If we have nothing to store, do nothing unless the expression has
|
||
side-effects. */
|
||
if (bitsize == 0)
|
||
return expand_expr (exp, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
else if (bitsize >= 0 && bitsize < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
width_mask = ((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1;
|
||
|
||
/* If we are storing into an unaligned field of an aligned union that is
|
||
in a register, we may have the mode of TARGET being an integer mode but
|
||
MODE == BLKmode. In that case, get an aligned object whose size and
|
||
alignment are the same as TARGET and store TARGET into it (we can avoid
|
||
the store if the field being stored is the entire width of TARGET). Then
|
||
call ourselves recursively to store the field into a BLKmode version of
|
||
that object. Finally, load from the object into TARGET. This is not
|
||
very efficient in general, but should only be slightly more expensive
|
||
than the otherwise-required unaligned accesses. Perhaps this can be
|
||
cleaned up later. It's tempting to make OBJECT readonly, but it's set
|
||
twice, once with emit_move_insn and once via store_field. */
|
||
|
||
if (mode == BLKmode
|
||
&& (REG_P (target) || GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx object = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
|
||
rtx blk_object = adjust_address (object, BLKmode, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (bitsize != (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (target)))
|
||
emit_move_insn (object, target);
|
||
|
||
store_field (blk_object, bitsize, bitpos, mode, exp, type, alias_set);
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, object);
|
||
|
||
/* We want to return the BLKmode version of the data. */
|
||
return blk_object;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (GET_CODE (target) == CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
/* We're storing into a struct containing a single __complex. */
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (!bitpos);
|
||
return store_expr (exp, target, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the structure is in a register or if the component
|
||
is a bit field, we cannot use addressing to access it.
|
||
Use bit-field techniques or SUBREG to store in it. */
|
||
|
||
if (mode == VOIDmode
|
||
|| (mode != BLKmode && ! direct_store[(int) mode]
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT)
|
||
|| REG_P (target)
|
||
|| GET_CODE (target) == SUBREG
|
||
/* If the field isn't aligned enough to store as an ordinary memref,
|
||
store it as a bit field. */
|
||
|| (mode != BLKmode
|
||
&& ((((MEM_ALIGN (target) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
|
||
|| bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode))
|
||
&& SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode, MEM_ALIGN (target)))
|
||
|| (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
|
||
/* If the RHS and field are a constant size and the size of the
|
||
RHS isn't the same size as the bitfield, we must use bitfield
|
||
operations. */
|
||
|| (bitsize >= 0
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), bitsize) != 0))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx temp;
|
||
|
||
/* If EXP is a NOP_EXPR of precision less than its mode, then that
|
||
implies a mask operation. If the precision is the same size as
|
||
the field we're storing into, that mask is redundant. This is
|
||
particularly common with bit field assignments generated by the
|
||
C front end. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == NOP_EXPR)
|
||
{
|
||
tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
|
||
if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type)
|
||
&& TYPE_PRECISION (type) < GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))
|
||
&& bitsize == TYPE_PRECISION (type))
|
||
{
|
||
type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
if (INTEGRAL_TYPE_P (type) && TYPE_PRECISION (type) >= bitsize)
|
||
exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
temp = expand_normal (exp);
|
||
|
||
/* If BITSIZE is narrower than the size of the type of EXP
|
||
we will be narrowing TEMP. Normally, what's wanted are the
|
||
low-order bits. However, if EXP's type is a record and this is
|
||
big-endian machine, we want the upper BITSIZE bits. */
|
||
if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN && GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (temp)) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == RECORD_TYPE)
|
||
temp = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (temp), temp,
|
||
size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (temp))
|
||
- bitsize),
|
||
NULL_RTX, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* Unless MODE is VOIDmode or BLKmode, convert TEMP to
|
||
MODE. */
|
||
if (mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
|
||
&& mode != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
|
||
temp = convert_modes (mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)), temp, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* If the modes of TARGET and TEMP are both BLKmode, both
|
||
must be in memory and BITPOS must be aligned on a byte
|
||
boundary. If so, we simply do a block copy. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE (target) == BLKmode && GET_MODE (temp) == BLKmode)
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (MEM_P (target) && MEM_P (temp)
|
||
&& !(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
|
||
|
||
target = adjust_address (target, VOIDmode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
emit_block_move (target, temp,
|
||
GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
|
||
/ BITS_PER_UNIT),
|
||
BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
|
||
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Store the value in the bitfield. */
|
||
store_bit_field (target, bitsize, bitpos, mode, temp);
|
||
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Now build a reference to just the desired component. */
|
||
rtx to_rtx = adjust_address (target, mode, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
|
||
if (to_rtx == target)
|
||
to_rtx = copy_rtx (to_rtx);
|
||
|
||
MEM_SET_IN_STRUCT_P (to_rtx, 1);
|
||
if (!MEM_KEEP_ALIAS_SET_P (to_rtx) && MEM_ALIAS_SET (to_rtx) != 0)
|
||
set_mem_alias_set (to_rtx, alias_set);
|
||
|
||
return store_expr (exp, to_rtx, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF, a BIT_FIELD_REF,
|
||
an ARRAY_REF, or an ARRAY_RANGE_REF, look for nested operations of these
|
||
codes and find the ultimate containing object, which we return.
|
||
|
||
We set *PBITSIZE to the size in bits that we want, *PBITPOS to the
|
||
bit position, and *PUNSIGNEDP to the signedness of the field.
|
||
If the position of the field is variable, we store a tree
|
||
giving the variable offset (in units) in *POFFSET.
|
||
This offset is in addition to the bit position.
|
||
If the position is not variable, we store 0 in *POFFSET.
|
||
|
||
If any of the extraction expressions is volatile,
|
||
we store 1 in *PVOLATILEP. Otherwise we don't change that.
|
||
|
||
If the field is a bit-field, *PMODE is set to VOIDmode. Otherwise, it
|
||
is a mode that can be used to access the field. In that case, *PBITSIZE
|
||
is redundant.
|
||
|
||
If the field describes a variable-sized object, *PMODE is set to
|
||
VOIDmode and *PBITSIZE is set to -1. An access cannot be made in
|
||
this case, but the address of the object can be found.
|
||
|
||
If KEEP_ALIGNING is true and the target is STRICT_ALIGNMENT, we don't
|
||
look through nodes that serve as markers of a greater alignment than
|
||
the one that can be deduced from the expression. These nodes make it
|
||
possible for front-ends to prevent temporaries from being created by
|
||
the middle-end on alignment considerations. For that purpose, the
|
||
normal operating mode at high-level is to always pass FALSE so that
|
||
the ultimate containing object is really returned; moreover, the
|
||
associated predicate handled_component_p will always return TRUE
|
||
on these nodes, thus indicating that they are essentially handled
|
||
by get_inner_reference. TRUE should only be passed when the caller
|
||
is scanning the expression in order to build another representation
|
||
and specifically knows how to handle these nodes; as such, this is
|
||
the normal operating mode in the RTL expanders. */
|
||
|
||
tree
|
||
get_inner_reference (tree exp, HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitsize,
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT *pbitpos, tree *poffset,
|
||
enum machine_mode *pmode, int *punsignedp,
|
||
int *pvolatilep, bool keep_aligning)
|
||
{
|
||
tree size_tree = 0;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = VOIDmode;
|
||
tree offset = size_zero_node;
|
||
tree bit_offset = bitsize_zero_node;
|
||
|
||
/* First get the mode, signedness, and size. We do this from just the
|
||
outermost expression. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == COMPONENT_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
size_tree = DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
||
if (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
|
||
mode = DECL_MODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
||
|
||
*punsignedp = DECL_UNSIGNED (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == BIT_FIELD_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
size_tree = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
*punsignedp = BIT_FIELD_REF_UNSIGNED (exp);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
|
||
*punsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
|
||
|
||
if (mode == BLKmode)
|
||
size_tree = TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
|
||
else
|
||
*pbitsize = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (size_tree != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! host_integerp (size_tree, 1))
|
||
mode = BLKmode, *pbitsize = -1;
|
||
else
|
||
*pbitsize = tree_low_cst (size_tree, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
*pmode = mode;
|
||
|
||
/* Compute cumulative bit-offset for nested component-refs and array-refs,
|
||
and find the ultimate containing object. */
|
||
while (1)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
case BIT_FIELD_REF:
|
||
bit_offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, bit_offset,
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case COMPONENT_REF:
|
||
{
|
||
tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
tree this_offset = component_ref_field_offset (exp);
|
||
|
||
/* If this field hasn't been filled in yet, don't go past it.
|
||
This should only happen when folding expressions made during
|
||
type construction. */
|
||
if (this_offset == 0)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset, this_offset);
|
||
bit_offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, bit_offset,
|
||
DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET (field));
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Right now we don't do anything with DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN. */
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case ARRAY_REF:
|
||
case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
|
||
{
|
||
tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
|
||
tree unit_size = array_ref_element_size (exp);
|
||
|
||
/* We assume all arrays have sizes that are a multiple of a byte.
|
||
First subtract the lower bound, if any, in the type of the
|
||
index, then convert to sizetype and multiply by the size of
|
||
the array element. */
|
||
if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
|
||
index = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (index),
|
||
index, low_bound);
|
||
|
||
offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, offset,
|
||
size_binop (MULT_EXPR,
|
||
fold_convert (sizetype, index),
|
||
unit_size));
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case REALPART_EXPR:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case IMAGPART_EXPR:
|
||
bit_offset = size_binop (PLUS_EXPR, bit_offset,
|
||
bitsize_int (*pbitsize));
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
if (keep_aligning && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
|
||
&& (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (exp))
|
||
> TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
|
||
&& (TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
|
||
< BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT)
|
||
&& (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (exp))
|
||
|| TYPE_ALIGN_OK (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
|
||
goto done;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
goto done;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If any reference in the chain is volatile, the effect is volatile. */
|
||
if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp))
|
||
*pvolatilep = 1;
|
||
|
||
exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
done:
|
||
|
||
/* If OFFSET is constant, see if we can return the whole thing as a
|
||
constant bit position. Make sure to handle overflow during
|
||
this conversion. */
|
||
if (host_integerp (offset, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
double_int tem = double_int_mul (tree_to_double_int (offset),
|
||
uhwi_to_double_int (BITS_PER_UNIT));
|
||
tem = double_int_add (tem, tree_to_double_int (bit_offset));
|
||
if (double_int_fits_in_shwi_p (tem))
|
||
{
|
||
*pbitpos = double_int_to_shwi (tem);
|
||
*poffset = NULL_TREE;
|
||
return exp;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, split it up. */
|
||
*pbitpos = tree_low_cst (bit_offset, 0);
|
||
*poffset = offset;
|
||
|
||
return exp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given an expression EXP that may be a COMPONENT_REF or an ARRAY_REF,
|
||
look for whether EXP or any nested component-refs within EXP is marked
|
||
as PACKED. */
|
||
|
||
bool
|
||
contains_packed_reference (tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
bool packed_p = false;
|
||
|
||
while (1)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
case COMPONENT_REF:
|
||
{
|
||
tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
packed_p = DECL_PACKED (field)
|
||
|| TYPE_PACKED (TREE_TYPE (field))
|
||
|| TYPE_PACKED (TREE_TYPE (exp));
|
||
if (packed_p)
|
||
goto done;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case BIT_FIELD_REF:
|
||
case ARRAY_REF:
|
||
case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
|
||
case REALPART_EXPR:
|
||
case IMAGPART_EXPR:
|
||
case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
goto done;
|
||
}
|
||
exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
done:
|
||
return packed_p;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a tree of sizetype representing the size, in bytes, of the element
|
||
of EXP, an ARRAY_REF. */
|
||
|
||
tree
|
||
array_ref_element_size (tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
tree aligned_size = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 3);
|
||
tree elmt_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
|
||
|
||
/* If a size was specified in the ARRAY_REF, it's the size measured
|
||
in alignment units of the element type. So multiply by that value. */
|
||
if (aligned_size)
|
||
{
|
||
/* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
|
||
sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
|
||
if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_size) != sizetype)
|
||
aligned_size = fold_convert (sizetype, aligned_size);
|
||
return size_binop (MULT_EXPR, aligned_size,
|
||
size_int (TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (elmt_type)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, take the size from that of the element type. Substitute
|
||
any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
|
||
else
|
||
return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (elmt_type), exp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a tree representing the lower bound of the array mentioned in
|
||
EXP, an ARRAY_REF. */
|
||
|
||
tree
|
||
array_ref_low_bound (tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
|
||
|
||
/* If a lower bound is specified in EXP, use it. */
|
||
if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2))
|
||
return TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, if there is a domain type and it has a lower bound, use it,
|
||
substituting for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
|
||
if (domain_type && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type))
|
||
return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, return a zero of the appropriate type. */
|
||
return build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)), 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a tree representing the upper bound of the array mentioned in
|
||
EXP, an ARRAY_REF. */
|
||
|
||
tree
|
||
array_ref_up_bound (tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
tree domain_type = TYPE_DOMAIN (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)));
|
||
|
||
/* If there is a domain type and it has an upper bound, use it, substituting
|
||
for a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR as needed. */
|
||
if (domain_type && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type))
|
||
return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain_type), exp);
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise fail. */
|
||
return NULL_TREE;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a tree representing the offset, in bytes, of the field referenced
|
||
by EXP. This does not include any offset in DECL_FIELD_BIT_OFFSET. */
|
||
|
||
tree
|
||
component_ref_field_offset (tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
tree aligned_offset = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
|
||
tree field = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* If an offset was specified in the COMPONENT_REF, it's the offset measured
|
||
in units of DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN / BITS_PER_UNIT. So multiply by that
|
||
value. */
|
||
if (aligned_offset)
|
||
{
|
||
/* ??? tree_ssa_useless_type_conversion will eliminate casts to
|
||
sizetype from another type of the same width and signedness. */
|
||
if (TREE_TYPE (aligned_offset) != sizetype)
|
||
aligned_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, aligned_offset);
|
||
return size_binop (MULT_EXPR, aligned_offset,
|
||
size_int (DECL_OFFSET_ALIGN (field) / BITS_PER_UNIT));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, take the offset from that of the field. Substitute
|
||
any PLACEHOLDER_EXPR that we have. */
|
||
else
|
||
return SUBSTITUTE_PLACEHOLDER_IN_EXPR (DECL_FIELD_OFFSET (field), exp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return 1 if T is an expression that get_inner_reference handles. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
handled_component_p (tree t)
|
||
{
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (t))
|
||
{
|
||
case BIT_FIELD_REF:
|
||
case COMPONENT_REF:
|
||
case ARRAY_REF:
|
||
case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
|
||
case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
case REALPART_EXPR:
|
||
case IMAGPART_EXPR:
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Given an rtx VALUE that may contain additions and multiplications, return
|
||
an equivalent value that just refers to a register, memory, or constant.
|
||
This is done by generating instructions to perform the arithmetic and
|
||
returning a pseudo-register containing the value.
|
||
|
||
The returned value may be a REG, SUBREG, MEM or constant. */
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
force_operand (rtx value, rtx target)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx op1, op2;
|
||
/* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
|
||
rtx subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
|
||
enum rtx_code code = GET_CODE (value);
|
||
|
||
/* Check for subreg applied to an expression produced by loop optimizer. */
|
||
if (code == SUBREG
|
||
&& !REG_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
|
||
&& !MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value)))
|
||
{
|
||
value = simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
|
||
force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
|
||
force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
|
||
NULL_RTX)),
|
||
GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
|
||
SUBREG_BYTE (value));
|
||
code = GET_CODE (value);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check for a PIC address load. */
|
||
if ((code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
|
||
&& XEXP (value, 0) == pic_offset_table_rtx
|
||
&& (GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == SYMBOL_REF
|
||
|| GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == LABEL_REF
|
||
|| GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 1)) == CONST))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!subtarget)
|
||
subtarget = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
|
||
emit_move_insn (subtarget, value);
|
||
return subtarget;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (ARITHMETIC_P (value))
|
||
{
|
||
op2 = XEXP (value, 1);
|
||
if (!CONSTANT_P (op2) && !(REG_P (op2) && op2 != subtarget))
|
||
subtarget = 0;
|
||
if (code == MINUS && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
code = PLUS;
|
||
op2 = negate_rtx (GET_MODE (value), op2);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Check for an addition with OP2 a constant integer and our first
|
||
operand a PLUS of a virtual register and something else. In that
|
||
case, we want to emit the sum of the virtual register and the
|
||
constant first and then add the other value. This allows virtual
|
||
register instantiation to simply modify the constant rather than
|
||
creating another one around this addition. */
|
||
if (code == PLUS && GET_CODE (op2) == CONST_INT
|
||
&& GET_CODE (XEXP (value, 0)) == PLUS
|
||
&& REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0))
|
||
&& REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) >= FIRST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER
|
||
&& REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0)) <= LAST_VIRTUAL_REGISTER)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx temp = expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code,
|
||
XEXP (XEXP (value, 0), 0), op2,
|
||
subtarget, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, temp,
|
||
force_operand (XEXP (XEXP (value,
|
||
0), 1), 0),
|
||
target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), subtarget);
|
||
op2 = force_operand (op2, NULL_RTX);
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case MULT:
|
||
return expand_mult (GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 1);
|
||
case DIV:
|
||
if (!INTEGRAL_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value)))
|
||
return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
|
||
target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
else
|
||
return expand_divmod (0,
|
||
FLOAT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (value))
|
||
? RDIV_EXPR : TRUNC_DIV_EXPR,
|
||
GET_MODE (value), op1, op2, target, 0);
|
||
break;
|
||
case MOD:
|
||
return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
|
||
target, 0);
|
||
break;
|
||
case UDIV:
|
||
return expand_divmod (0, TRUNC_DIV_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
|
||
target, 1);
|
||
break;
|
||
case UMOD:
|
||
return expand_divmod (1, TRUNC_MOD_EXPR, GET_MODE (value), op1, op2,
|
||
target, 1);
|
||
break;
|
||
case ASHIFTRT:
|
||
return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
|
||
target, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
break;
|
||
default:
|
||
return expand_simple_binop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, op2,
|
||
target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
if (UNARY_P (value))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!target)
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (value));
|
||
op1 = force_operand (XEXP (value, 0), NULL_RTX);
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case ZERO_EXTEND:
|
||
case SIGN_EXTEND:
|
||
case TRUNCATE:
|
||
case FLOAT_EXTEND:
|
||
case FLOAT_TRUNCATE:
|
||
convert_move (target, op1, code == ZERO_EXTEND);
|
||
return target;
|
||
|
||
case FIX:
|
||
case UNSIGNED_FIX:
|
||
expand_fix (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FIX);
|
||
return target;
|
||
|
||
case FLOAT:
|
||
case UNSIGNED_FLOAT:
|
||
expand_float (target, op1, code == UNSIGNED_FLOAT);
|
||
return target;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return expand_simple_unop (GET_MODE (value), code, op1, target, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
#ifdef INSN_SCHEDULING
|
||
/* On machines that have insn scheduling, we want all memory reference to be
|
||
explicit, so we need to deal with such paradoxical SUBREGs. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (value) == SUBREG && MEM_P (SUBREG_REG (value))
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (value))
|
||
> GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)))))
|
||
value
|
||
= simplify_gen_subreg (GET_MODE (value),
|
||
force_reg (GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
|
||
force_operand (SUBREG_REG (value),
|
||
NULL_RTX)),
|
||
GET_MODE (SUBREG_REG (value)),
|
||
SUBREG_BYTE (value));
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
return value;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Subroutine of expand_expr: return nonzero iff there is no way that
|
||
EXP can reference X, which is being modified. TOP_P is nonzero if this
|
||
call is going to be used to determine whether we need a temporary
|
||
for EXP, as opposed to a recursive call to this function.
|
||
|
||
It is always safe for this routine to return zero since it merely
|
||
searches for optimization opportunities. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
safe_from_p (rtx x, tree exp, int top_p)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx exp_rtl = 0;
|
||
int i, nops;
|
||
|
||
if (x == 0
|
||
/* If EXP has varying size, we MUST use a target since we currently
|
||
have no way of allocating temporaries of variable size
|
||
(except for arrays that have TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE set).
|
||
So we assume here that something at a higher level has prevented a
|
||
clash. This is somewhat bogus, but the best we can do. Only
|
||
do this when X is BLKmode and when we are at the top level. */
|
||
|| (top_p && TREE_TYPE (exp) != 0 && COMPLETE_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) != INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) != ARRAY_TYPE
|
||
|| TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == NULL_TREE
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (TYPE_ARRAY_MAX_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)))
|
||
!= INTEGER_CST)
|
||
&& GET_MODE (x) == BLKmode)
|
||
/* If X is in the outgoing argument area, it is always safe. */
|
||
|| (MEM_P (x)
|
||
&& (XEXP (x, 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx
|
||
|| (GET_CODE (XEXP (x, 0)) == PLUS
|
||
&& XEXP (XEXP (x, 0), 0) == virtual_outgoing_args_rtx))))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a subreg of a hard register, declare it unsafe, otherwise,
|
||
find the underlying pseudo. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (x) == SUBREG)
|
||
{
|
||
x = SUBREG_REG (x);
|
||
if (REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now look at our tree code and possibly recurse. */
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (exp)))
|
||
{
|
||
case tcc_declaration:
|
||
exp_rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (exp);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case tcc_constant:
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
case tcc_exceptional:
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TREE_LIST)
|
||
{
|
||
while (1)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_VALUE (exp) && !safe_from_p (x, TREE_VALUE (exp), 0))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
exp = TREE_CHAIN (exp);
|
||
if (!exp)
|
||
return 1;
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) != TREE_LIST)
|
||
return safe_from_p (x, exp, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR)
|
||
{
|
||
constructor_elt *ce;
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
|
||
|
||
for (idx = 0;
|
||
VEC_iterate (constructor_elt, CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, ce);
|
||
idx++)
|
||
if ((ce->index != NULL_TREE && !safe_from_p (x, ce->index, 0))
|
||
|| !safe_from_p (x, ce->value, 0))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK)
|
||
return 1; /* An already-visited SAVE_EXPR? */
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
case tcc_statement:
|
||
/* The only case we look at here is the DECL_INITIAL inside a
|
||
DECL_EXPR. */
|
||
return (TREE_CODE (exp) != DECL_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)) != VAR_DECL
|
||
|| !DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp))
|
||
|| safe_from_p (x, DECL_INITIAL (DECL_EXPR_DECL (exp)), 0));
|
||
|
||
case tcc_binary:
|
||
case tcc_comparison:
|
||
if (!safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
/* Fall through. */
|
||
|
||
case tcc_unary:
|
||
return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
|
||
|
||
case tcc_expression:
|
||
case tcc_reference:
|
||
/* Now do code-specific tests. EXP_RTL is set to any rtx we find in
|
||
the expression. If it is set, we conflict iff we are that rtx or
|
||
both are in memory. Otherwise, we check all operands of the
|
||
expression recursively. */
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
case ADDR_EXPR:
|
||
/* If the operand is static or we are static, we can't conflict.
|
||
Likewise if we don't conflict with the operand at all. */
|
||
if (staticp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
|
||
|| TREE_STATIC (exp)
|
||
|| safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, the only way this can conflict is if we are taking
|
||
the address of a DECL a that address if part of X, which is
|
||
very rare. */
|
||
exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
if (DECL_P (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!DECL_RTL_SET_P (exp)
|
||
|| !MEM_P (DECL_RTL (exp)))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
else
|
||
exp_rtl = XEXP (DECL_RTL (exp), 0);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF:
|
||
case ALIGN_INDIRECT_REF:
|
||
case INDIRECT_REF:
|
||
if (MEM_P (x)
|
||
&& alias_sets_conflict_p (MEM_ALIAS_SET (x),
|
||
get_alias_set (exp)))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case CALL_EXPR:
|
||
/* Assume that the call will clobber all hard registers and
|
||
all of memory. */
|
||
if ((REG_P (x) && REGNO (x) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
|| MEM_P (x))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
|
||
case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
|
||
/* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
|
||
case SAVE_EXPR:
|
||
return safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we have an rtx, we do not need to scan our operands. */
|
||
if (exp_rtl)
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
nops = TREE_CODE_LENGTH (TREE_CODE (exp));
|
||
for (i = 0; i < nops; i++)
|
||
if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, i) != 0
|
||
&& ! safe_from_p (x, TREE_OPERAND (exp, i), 0))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a language-specific tree code, it may require
|
||
special handling. */
|
||
if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (exp)
|
||
>= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE
|
||
&& !lang_hooks.safe_from_p (x, exp))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case tcc_type:
|
||
/* Should never get a type here. */
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we have an rtl, find any enclosed object. Then see if we conflict
|
||
with it. */
|
||
if (exp_rtl)
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (exp_rtl) == SUBREG)
|
||
{
|
||
exp_rtl = SUBREG_REG (exp_rtl);
|
||
if (REG_P (exp_rtl)
|
||
&& REGNO (exp_rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the rtl is X, then it is not safe. Otherwise, it is unless both
|
||
are memory and they conflict. */
|
||
return ! (rtx_equal_p (x, exp_rtl)
|
||
|| (MEM_P (x) && MEM_P (exp_rtl)
|
||
&& true_dependence (exp_rtl, VOIDmode, x,
|
||
rtx_addr_varies_p)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we reach here, it is safe. */
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Return the highest power of two that EXP is known to be a multiple of.
|
||
This is used in updating alignment of MEMs in array references. */
|
||
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
|
||
highest_pow2_factor (tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT c0, c1;
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
case INTEGER_CST:
|
||
/* We can find the lowest bit that's a one. If the low
|
||
HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT bits are zero, return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT.
|
||
We need to handle this case since we can find it in a COND_EXPR,
|
||
a MIN_EXPR, or a MAX_EXPR. If the constant overflows, we have an
|
||
erroneous program, so return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT to avoid any
|
||
later ICE. */
|
||
if (TREE_CONSTANT_OVERFLOW (exp))
|
||
return BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Note: tree_low_cst is intentionally not used here,
|
||
we don't care about the upper bits. */
|
||
c0 = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp);
|
||
c0 &= -c0;
|
||
return c0 ? c0 : BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT;
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case PLUS_EXPR: case MINUS_EXPR: case MIN_EXPR: case MAX_EXPR:
|
||
c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
||
return MIN (c0, c1);
|
||
|
||
case MULT_EXPR:
|
||
c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
||
return c0 * c1;
|
||
|
||
case ROUND_DIV_EXPR: case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR: case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
|
||
case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
|
||
if (integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
|
||
&& host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
|
||
{
|
||
c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
c1 = tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1);
|
||
return MAX (1, c0 / c1);
|
||
}
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case NON_LVALUE_EXPR: case NOP_EXPR: case CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
case SAVE_EXPR:
|
||
return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
|
||
case COMPOUND_EXPR:
|
||
return highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
||
|
||
case COND_EXPR:
|
||
c0 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
||
c1 = highest_pow2_factor (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2));
|
||
return MIN (c0, c1);
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Similar, except that the alignment requirements of TARGET are
|
||
taken into account. Assume it is at least as aligned as its
|
||
type, unless it is a COMPONENT_REF in which case the layout of
|
||
the structure gives the alignment. */
|
||
|
||
static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
|
||
highest_pow2_factor_for_target (tree target, tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT target_align, factor;
|
||
|
||
factor = highest_pow2_factor (exp);
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (target) == COMPONENT_REF)
|
||
target_align = DECL_ALIGN_UNIT (TREE_OPERAND (target, 1));
|
||
else
|
||
target_align = TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (TREE_TYPE (target));
|
||
return MAX (factor, target_align);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Expands variable VAR. */
|
||
|
||
void
|
||
expand_var (tree var)
|
||
{
|
||
if (DECL_EXTERNAL (var))
|
||
return;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_STATIC (var))
|
||
/* If this is an inlined copy of a static local variable,
|
||
look up the original decl. */
|
||
var = DECL_ORIGIN (var);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_STATIC (var)
|
||
? !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (var)
|
||
: !DECL_RTL_SET_P (var))
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (var) == VAR_DECL && DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (var))
|
||
/* Should be ignored. */;
|
||
else if (lang_hooks.expand_decl (var))
|
||
/* OK. */;
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (var) == VAR_DECL && !TREE_STATIC (var))
|
||
expand_decl (var);
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (var) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (var))
|
||
rest_of_decl_compilation (var, 0, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
/* No expansion needed. */
|
||
gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (var) == TYPE_DECL
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (var) == CONST_DECL
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (var) == FUNCTION_DECL
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (var) == LABEL_DECL);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Subroutine of expand_expr. Expand the two operands of a binary
|
||
expression EXP0 and EXP1 placing the results in OP0 and OP1.
|
||
The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero. The
|
||
MODIFIER argument is as documented by expand_expr. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
expand_operands (tree exp0, tree exp1, rtx target, rtx *op0, rtx *op1,
|
||
enum expand_modifier modifier)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! safe_from_p (target, exp1, 1))
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
if (operand_equal_p (exp0, exp1, 0))
|
||
{
|
||
*op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
*op1 = copy_rtx (*op0);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* If we need to preserve evaluation order, copy exp0 into its own
|
||
temporary variable so that it can't be clobbered by exp1. */
|
||
if (flag_evaluation_order && TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp1))
|
||
exp0 = save_expr (exp0);
|
||
*op0 = expand_expr (exp0, target, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
*op1 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Return a MEM that contains constant EXP. DEFER is as for
|
||
output_constant_def and MODIFIER is as for expand_expr. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
expand_expr_constant (tree exp, int defer, enum expand_modifier modifier)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx mem;
|
||
|
||
mem = output_constant_def (exp, defer);
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
mem = use_anchored_address (mem);
|
||
return mem;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of expand_expr_addr_expr. Evaluate the address of EXP.
|
||
The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
|
||
enum expand_modifier modifier)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx result, subtarget;
|
||
tree inner, offset;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
|
||
int volatilep, unsignedp;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode1;
|
||
|
||
/* If we are taking the address of a constant and are at the top level,
|
||
we have to use output_constant_def since we can't call force_const_mem
|
||
at top level. */
|
||
/* ??? This should be considered a front-end bug. We should not be
|
||
generating ADDR_EXPR of something that isn't an LVALUE. The only
|
||
exception here is STRING_CST. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == CONSTRUCTOR
|
||
|| CONSTANT_CLASS_P (exp))
|
||
return XEXP (expand_expr_constant (exp, 0, modifier), 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Everything must be something allowed by is_gimple_addressable. */
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
case INDIRECT_REF:
|
||
/* This case will happen via recursion for &a->b. */
|
||
return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode, modifier);
|
||
|
||
case CONST_DECL:
|
||
/* Recurse and make the output_constant_def clause above handle this. */
|
||
return expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target,
|
||
tmode, modifier);
|
||
|
||
case REALPART_EXPR:
|
||
/* The real part of the complex number is always first, therefore
|
||
the address is the same as the address of the parent object. */
|
||
offset = 0;
|
||
bitpos = 0;
|
||
inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case IMAGPART_EXPR:
|
||
/* The imaginary part of the complex number is always second.
|
||
The expression is therefore always offset by the size of the
|
||
scalar type. */
|
||
offset = 0;
|
||
bitpos = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
|
||
inner = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
/* If the object is a DECL, then expand it for its rtl. Don't bypass
|
||
expand_expr, as that can have various side effects; LABEL_DECLs for
|
||
example, may not have their DECL_RTL set yet. Assume language
|
||
specific tree nodes can be expanded in some interesting way. */
|
||
if (DECL_P (exp)
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (exp) >= LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
|
||
{
|
||
result = expand_expr (exp, target, tmode,
|
||
modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS);
|
||
|
||
/* If the DECL isn't in memory, then the DECL wasn't properly
|
||
marked TREE_ADDRESSABLE, which will be either a front-end
|
||
or a tree optimizer bug. */
|
||
gcc_assert (MEM_P (result));
|
||
result = XEXP (result, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Is this needed anymore? */
|
||
if (DECL_P (exp) && !TREE_USED (exp) == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
assemble_external (exp);
|
||
TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
|
||
result = force_operand (result, target);
|
||
return result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Pass FALSE as the last argument to get_inner_reference although
|
||
we are expanding to RTL. The rationale is that we know how to
|
||
handle "aligning nodes" here: we can just bypass them because
|
||
they won't change the final object whose address will be returned
|
||
(they actually exist only for that purpose). */
|
||
inner = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
|
||
&mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We must have made progress. */
|
||
gcc_assert (inner != exp);
|
||
|
||
subtarget = offset || bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
|
||
result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (inner, subtarget, tmode, modifier);
|
||
|
||
if (offset)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx tmp;
|
||
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_NORMAL)
|
||
result = force_operand (result, NULL);
|
||
tmp = expand_expr (offset, NULL, tmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
|
||
result = convert_memory_address (tmode, result);
|
||
tmp = convert_memory_address (tmode, tmp);
|
||
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
result = gen_rtx_PLUS (tmode, result, tmp);
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
subtarget = bitpos ? NULL_RTX : target;
|
||
result = expand_simple_binop (tmode, PLUS, result, tmp, subtarget,
|
||
1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (bitpos)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Someone beforehand should have rejected taking the address
|
||
of such an object. */
|
||
gcc_assert ((bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT) == 0);
|
||
|
||
result = plus_constant (result, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
if (modifier < EXPAND_SUM)
|
||
result = force_operand (result, target);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* A subroutine of expand_expr. Evaluate EXP, which is an ADDR_EXPR.
|
||
The TARGET, TMODE and MODIFIER arguments are as for expand_expr. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
expand_expr_addr_expr (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
|
||
enum expand_modifier modifier)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode rmode;
|
||
rtx result;
|
||
|
||
/* Target mode of VOIDmode says "whatever's natural". */
|
||
if (tmode == VOIDmode)
|
||
tmode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
|
||
|
||
/* We can get called with some Weird Things if the user does silliness
|
||
like "(short) &a". In that case, convert_memory_address won't do
|
||
the right thing, so ignore the given target mode. */
|
||
if (tmode != Pmode && tmode != ptr_mode)
|
||
tmode = Pmode;
|
||
|
||
result = expand_expr_addr_expr_1 (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target,
|
||
tmode, modifier);
|
||
|
||
/* Despite expand_expr claims concerning ignoring TMODE when not
|
||
strictly convenient, stuff breaks if we don't honor it. Note
|
||
that combined with the above, we only do this for pointer modes. */
|
||
rmode = GET_MODE (result);
|
||
if (rmode == VOIDmode)
|
||
rmode = tmode;
|
||
if (rmode != tmode)
|
||
result = convert_memory_address (tmode, result);
|
||
|
||
return result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* expand_expr: generate code for computing expression EXP.
|
||
An rtx for the computed value is returned. The value is never null.
|
||
In the case of a void EXP, const0_rtx is returned.
|
||
|
||
The value may be stored in TARGET if TARGET is nonzero.
|
||
TARGET is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
|
||
the rtx returned may not be the same as TARGET.
|
||
|
||
If TARGET is CONST0_RTX, it means that the value will be ignored.
|
||
|
||
If TMODE is not VOIDmode, it suggests generating the
|
||
result in mode TMODE. But this is done only when convenient.
|
||
Otherwise, TMODE is ignored and the value generated in its natural mode.
|
||
TMODE is just a suggestion; callers must assume that
|
||
the rtx returned may not have mode TMODE.
|
||
|
||
Note that TARGET may have neither TMODE nor MODE. In that case, it
|
||
probably will not be used.
|
||
|
||
If MODIFIER is EXPAND_SUM then when EXP is an addition
|
||
we can return an rtx of the form (MULT (REG ...) (CONST_INT ...))
|
||
or a nest of (PLUS ...) and (MINUS ...) where the terms are
|
||
products as above, or REG or MEM, or constant.
|
||
Ordinarily in such cases we would output mul or add instructions
|
||
and then return a pseudo reg containing the sum.
|
||
|
||
EXPAND_INITIALIZER is much like EXPAND_SUM except that
|
||
it also marks a label as absolutely required (it can't be dead).
|
||
It also makes a ZERO_EXTEND or SIGN_EXTEND instead of emitting extend insns.
|
||
This is used for outputting expressions used in initializers.
|
||
|
||
EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS says that it is okay to return a MEM
|
||
with a constant address even if that address is not normally legitimate.
|
||
EXPAND_INITIALIZER and EXPAND_SUM also have this effect.
|
||
|
||
EXPAND_STACK_PARM is used when expanding to a TARGET on the stack for
|
||
a call parameter. Such targets require special care as we haven't yet
|
||
marked TARGET so that it's safe from being trashed by libcalls. We
|
||
don't want to use TARGET for anything but the final result;
|
||
Intermediate values must go elsewhere. Additionally, calls to
|
||
emit_block_move will be flagged with BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM.
|
||
|
||
If EXP is a VAR_DECL whose DECL_RTL was a MEM with an invalid
|
||
address, and ALT_RTL is non-NULL, then *ALT_RTL is set to the
|
||
DECL_RTL of the VAR_DECL. *ALT_RTL is also set if EXP is a
|
||
COMPOUND_EXPR whose second argument is such a VAR_DECL, and so on
|
||
recursively. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx expand_expr_real_1 (tree, rtx, enum machine_mode,
|
||
enum expand_modifier, rtx *);
|
||
|
||
rtx
|
||
expand_expr_real (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
|
||
enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
|
||
{
|
||
int rn = -1;
|
||
rtx ret, last = NULL;
|
||
|
||
/* Handle ERROR_MARK before anybody tries to access its type. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == ERROR_MARK
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)) == ERROR_MARK)
|
||
{
|
||
ret = CONST0_RTX (tmode);
|
||
return ret ? ret : const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (flag_non_call_exceptions)
|
||
{
|
||
rn = lookup_stmt_eh_region (exp);
|
||
/* If rn < 0, then either (1) tree-ssa not used or (2) doesn't throw. */
|
||
if (rn >= 0)
|
||
last = get_last_insn ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is an expression of some kind and it has an associated line
|
||
number, then emit the line number before expanding the expression.
|
||
|
||
We need to save and restore the file and line information so that
|
||
errors discovered during expansion are emitted with the right
|
||
information. It would be better of the diagnostic routines
|
||
used the file/line information embedded in the tree nodes rather
|
||
than globals. */
|
||
if (cfun && cfun->ib_boundaries_block && EXPR_HAS_LOCATION (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
location_t saved_location = input_location;
|
||
input_location = EXPR_LOCATION (exp);
|
||
emit_line_note (input_location);
|
||
|
||
/* Record where the insns produced belong. */
|
||
record_block_change (TREE_BLOCK (exp));
|
||
|
||
ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
|
||
|
||
input_location = saved_location;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
ret = expand_expr_real_1 (exp, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If using non-call exceptions, mark all insns that may trap.
|
||
expand_call() will mark CALL_INSNs before we get to this code,
|
||
but it doesn't handle libcalls, and these may trap. */
|
||
if (rn >= 0)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
for (insn = next_real_insn (last); insn;
|
||
insn = next_real_insn (insn))
|
||
{
|
||
if (! find_reg_note (insn, REG_EH_REGION, NULL_RTX)
|
||
/* If we want exceptions for non-call insns, any
|
||
may_trap_p instruction may throw. */
|
||
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != CLOBBER
|
||
&& GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) != USE
|
||
&& (CALL_P (insn) || may_trap_p (PATTERN (insn))))
|
||
{
|
||
REG_NOTES (insn) = alloc_EXPR_LIST (REG_EH_REGION, GEN_INT (rn),
|
||
REG_NOTES (insn));
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
expand_expr_real_1 (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode tmode,
|
||
enum expand_modifier modifier, rtx *alt_rtl)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx op0, op1, temp, decl_rtl;
|
||
tree type = TREE_TYPE (exp);
|
||
int unsignedp;
|
||
enum machine_mode mode;
|
||
enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (exp);
|
||
optab this_optab;
|
||
rtx subtarget, original_target;
|
||
int ignore;
|
||
tree context, subexp0, subexp1;
|
||
bool reduce_bit_field = false;
|
||
#define REDUCE_BIT_FIELD(expr) (reduce_bit_field && !ignore \
|
||
? reduce_to_bit_field_precision ((expr), \
|
||
target, \
|
||
type) \
|
||
: (expr))
|
||
|
||
mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
|
||
unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
|
||
if (lang_hooks.reduce_bit_field_operations
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
|
||
&& GET_MODE_PRECISION (mode) > TYPE_PRECISION (type))
|
||
{
|
||
/* An operation in what may be a bit-field type needs the
|
||
result to be reduced to the precision of the bit-field type,
|
||
which is narrower than that of the type's mode. */
|
||
reduce_bit_field = true;
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Use subtarget as the target for operand 0 of a binary operation. */
|
||
subtarget = get_subtarget (target);
|
||
original_target = target;
|
||
ignore = (target == const0_rtx
|
||
|| ((code == NON_LVALUE_EXPR || code == NOP_EXPR
|
||
|| code == CONVERT_EXPR || code == COND_EXPR
|
||
|| code == VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE));
|
||
|
||
/* If we are going to ignore this result, we need only do something
|
||
if there is a side-effect somewhere in the expression. If there
|
||
is, short-circuit the most common cases here. Note that we must
|
||
not call expand_expr with anything but const0_rtx in case this
|
||
is an initial expansion of a size that contains a PLACEHOLDER_EXPR. */
|
||
|
||
if (ignore)
|
||
{
|
||
if (! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (exp))
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
/* Ensure we reference a volatile object even if value is ignored, but
|
||
don't do this if all we are doing is taking its address. */
|
||
if (TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (exp)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (exp) != FUNCTION_DECL
|
||
&& mode != VOIDmode && mode != BLKmode
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
|
||
{
|
||
temp = expand_expr (exp, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
if (MEM_P (temp))
|
||
temp = copy_to_reg (temp);
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_unary
|
||
|| code == COMPONENT_REF || code == INDIRECT_REF)
|
||
return expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode,
|
||
modifier);
|
||
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_binary
|
||
|| TREE_CODE_CLASS (code) == tcc_comparison
|
||
|| code == ARRAY_REF || code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (code == BIT_FIELD_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
switch (code)
|
||
{
|
||
case LABEL_DECL:
|
||
{
|
||
tree function = decl_function_context (exp);
|
||
|
||
temp = label_rtx (exp);
|
||
temp = gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, temp);
|
||
|
||
if (function != current_function_decl
|
||
&& function != 0)
|
||
LABEL_REF_NONLOCAL_P (temp) = 1;
|
||
|
||
temp = gen_rtx_MEM (FUNCTION_MODE, temp);
|
||
return temp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case SSA_NAME:
|
||
return expand_expr_real_1 (SSA_NAME_VAR (exp), target, tmode, modifier,
|
||
NULL);
|
||
|
||
case PARM_DECL:
|
||
case VAR_DECL:
|
||
/* If a static var's type was incomplete when the decl was written,
|
||
but the type is complete now, lay out the decl now. */
|
||
if (DECL_SIZE (exp) == 0
|
||
&& COMPLETE_OR_UNBOUND_ARRAY_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp))
|
||
&& (TREE_STATIC (exp) || DECL_EXTERNAL (exp)))
|
||
layout_decl (exp, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case FUNCTION_DECL:
|
||
case RESULT_DECL:
|
||
decl_rtl = DECL_RTL (exp);
|
||
gcc_assert (decl_rtl);
|
||
|
||
/* Ensure variable marked as used even if it doesn't go through
|
||
a parser. If it hasn't be used yet, write out an external
|
||
definition. */
|
||
if (! TREE_USED (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
assemble_external (exp);
|
||
TREE_USED (exp) = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Show we haven't gotten RTL for this yet. */
|
||
temp = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Variables inherited from containing functions should have
|
||
been lowered by this point. */
|
||
context = decl_function_context (exp);
|
||
gcc_assert (!context
|
||
|| context == current_function_decl
|
||
|| TREE_STATIC (exp)
|
||
/* ??? C++ creates functions that are not TREE_STATIC. */
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (exp) == FUNCTION_DECL);
|
||
|
||
/* This is the case of an array whose size is to be determined
|
||
from its initializer, while the initializer is still being parsed.
|
||
See expand_decl. */
|
||
|
||
if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && REG_P (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))
|
||
temp = validize_mem (decl_rtl);
|
||
|
||
/* If DECL_RTL is memory, we are in the normal case and either
|
||
the address is not valid or it is not a register and -fforce-addr
|
||
is specified, get the address into a register. */
|
||
|
||
else if (MEM_P (decl_rtl) && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
{
|
||
if (alt_rtl)
|
||
*alt_rtl = decl_rtl;
|
||
decl_rtl = use_anchored_address (decl_rtl);
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_SUM
|
||
&& (!memory_address_p (DECL_MODE (exp), XEXP (decl_rtl, 0))
|
||
|| (flag_force_addr && !REG_P (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)))))
|
||
temp = replace_equiv_address (decl_rtl,
|
||
copy_rtx (XEXP (decl_rtl, 0)));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If we got something, return it. But first, set the alignment
|
||
if the address is a register. */
|
||
if (temp != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (MEM_P (temp) && REG_P (XEXP (temp, 0)))
|
||
mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (temp, 0), DECL_ALIGN (exp));
|
||
|
||
return temp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the mode of DECL_RTL does not match that of the decl, it
|
||
must be a promoted value. We return a SUBREG of the wanted mode,
|
||
but mark it so that we know that it was already extended. */
|
||
|
||
if (REG_P (decl_rtl)
|
||
&& GET_MODE (decl_rtl) != DECL_MODE (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode pmode;
|
||
|
||
/* Get the signedness used for this variable. Ensure we get the
|
||
same mode we got when the variable was declared. */
|
||
pmode = promote_mode (type, DECL_MODE (exp), &unsignedp,
|
||
(TREE_CODE (exp) == RESULT_DECL
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (exp) == PARM_DECL) ? 1 : 0);
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_MODE (decl_rtl) == pmode);
|
||
|
||
temp = gen_lowpart_SUBREG (mode, decl_rtl);
|
||
SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (temp) = 1;
|
||
SUBREG_PROMOTED_UNSIGNED_SET (temp, unsignedp);
|
||
return temp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return decl_rtl;
|
||
|
||
case INTEGER_CST:
|
||
temp = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (exp),
|
||
TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (exp), mode);
|
||
|
||
/* ??? If overflow is set, fold will have done an incomplete job,
|
||
which can result in (plus xx (const_int 0)), which can get
|
||
simplified by validate_replace_rtx during virtual register
|
||
instantiation, which can result in unrecognizable insns.
|
||
Avoid this by forcing all overflows into registers. */
|
||
if (TREE_CONSTANT_OVERFLOW (exp)
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
temp = force_reg (mode, temp);
|
||
|
||
return temp;
|
||
|
||
case VECTOR_CST:
|
||
{
|
||
tree tmp = NULL_TREE;
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_INT
|
||
|| GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
|
||
return const_vector_from_tree (exp);
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
tree type_for_mode = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, 1);
|
||
if (type_for_mode)
|
||
tmp = fold_unary (VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR, type_for_mode, exp);
|
||
}
|
||
if (!tmp)
|
||
tmp = build_constructor_from_list (type,
|
||
TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp));
|
||
return expand_expr (tmp, ignore ? const0_rtx : target,
|
||
tmode, modifier);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case CONST_DECL:
|
||
return expand_expr (DECL_INITIAL (exp), target, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
|
||
case REAL_CST:
|
||
/* If optimized, generate immediate CONST_DOUBLE
|
||
which will be turned into memory by reload if necessary.
|
||
|
||
We used to force a register so that loop.c could see it. But
|
||
this does not allow gen_* patterns to perform optimizations with
|
||
the constants. It also produces two insns in cases like "x = 1.0;".
|
||
On most machines, floating-point constants are not permitted in
|
||
many insns, so we'd end up copying it to a register in any case.
|
||
|
||
Now, we do the copying in expand_binop, if appropriate. */
|
||
return CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (exp),
|
||
TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
|
||
|
||
case COMPLEX_CST:
|
||
/* Handle evaluating a complex constant in a CONCAT target. */
|
||
if (original_target && GET_CODE (original_target) == CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
|
||
rtx rtarg, itarg;
|
||
|
||
rtarg = XEXP (original_target, 0);
|
||
itarg = XEXP (original_target, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* Move the real and imaginary parts separately. */
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_REALPART (exp), rtarg, mode, 0);
|
||
op1 = expand_expr (TREE_IMAGPART (exp), itarg, mode, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (op0 != rtarg)
|
||
emit_move_insn (rtarg, op0);
|
||
if (op1 != itarg)
|
||
emit_move_insn (itarg, op1);
|
||
|
||
return original_target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* ... fall through ... */
|
||
|
||
case STRING_CST:
|
||
temp = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
|
||
|
||
/* temp contains a constant address.
|
||
On RISC machines where a constant address isn't valid,
|
||
make some insns to get that address into a register. */
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_SUM
|
||
&& (! memory_address_p (mode, XEXP (temp, 0))
|
||
|| flag_force_addr))
|
||
return replace_equiv_address (temp,
|
||
copy_rtx (XEXP (temp, 0)));
|
||
return temp;
|
||
|
||
case SAVE_EXPR:
|
||
{
|
||
tree val = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
rtx ret = expand_expr_real_1 (val, target, tmode, modifier, alt_rtl);
|
||
|
||
if (!SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
/* We can indeed still hit this case, typically via builtin
|
||
expanders calling save_expr immediately before expanding
|
||
something. Assume this means that we only have to deal
|
||
with non-BLKmode values. */
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_MODE (ret) != BLKmode);
|
||
|
||
val = build_decl (VAR_DECL, NULL, TREE_TYPE (exp));
|
||
DECL_ARTIFICIAL (val) = 1;
|
||
DECL_IGNORED_P (val) = 1;
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = val;
|
||
SAVE_EXPR_RESOLVED_P (exp) = 1;
|
||
|
||
if (!CONSTANT_P (ret))
|
||
ret = copy_to_reg (ret);
|
||
SET_DECL_RTL (val, ret);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return ret;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case GOTO_EXPR:
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == LABEL_DECL)
|
||
expand_goto (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
else
|
||
expand_computed_goto (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
case CONSTRUCTOR:
|
||
/* If we don't need the result, just ensure we evaluate any
|
||
subexpressions. */
|
||
if (ignore)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
|
||
tree value;
|
||
|
||
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (exp), idx, value)
|
||
expand_expr (value, const0_rtx, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Try to avoid creating a temporary at all. This is possible
|
||
if all of the initializer is zero.
|
||
FIXME: try to handle all [0..255] initializers we can handle
|
||
with memset. */
|
||
else if (TREE_STATIC (exp)
|
||
&& !TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
|
||
&& target != 0 && mode == BLKmode
|
||
&& all_zeros_p (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
clear_storage (target, expr_size (exp), BLOCK_OP_NORMAL);
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* All elts simple constants => refer to a constant in memory. But
|
||
if this is a non-BLKmode mode, let it store a field at a time
|
||
since that should make a CONST_INT or CONST_DOUBLE when we
|
||
fold. Likewise, if we have a target we can use, it is best to
|
||
store directly into the target unless the type is large enough
|
||
that memcpy will be used. If we are making an initializer and
|
||
all operands are constant, put it in memory as well.
|
||
|
||
FIXME: Avoid trying to fill vector constructors piece-meal.
|
||
Output them with output_constant_def below unless we're sure
|
||
they're zeros. This should go away when vector initializers
|
||
are treated like VECTOR_CST instead of arrays.
|
||
*/
|
||
else if ((TREE_STATIC (exp)
|
||
&& ((mode == BLKmode
|
||
&& ! (target != 0 && safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)))
|
||
|| TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp)
|
||
|| (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1)
|
||
&& (! MOVE_BY_PIECES_P
|
||
(tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE_UNIT (type), 1),
|
||
TYPE_ALIGN (type)))
|
||
&& ! mostly_zeros_p (exp))))
|
||
|| ((modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS)
|
||
&& TREE_CONSTANT (exp)))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx constructor = expand_expr_constant (exp, 1, modifier);
|
||
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_SUM)
|
||
constructor = validize_mem (constructor);
|
||
|
||
return constructor;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
/* Handle calls that pass values in multiple non-contiguous
|
||
locations. The Irix 6 ABI has examples of this. */
|
||
if (target == 0 || ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
|
||
|| GET_CODE (target) == PARALLEL
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target
|
||
= assign_temp (build_qualified_type (type,
|
||
(TYPE_QUALS (type)
|
||
| (TREE_READONLY (exp)
|
||
* TYPE_QUAL_CONST))),
|
||
0, TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp), 1);
|
||
|
||
store_constructor (exp, target, 0, int_expr_size (exp));
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF:
|
||
case ALIGN_INDIRECT_REF:
|
||
case INDIRECT_REF:
|
||
{
|
||
tree exp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_WRITE)
|
||
{
|
||
tree t;
|
||
|
||
t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
|
||
if (t)
|
||
return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (exp1, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_SUM);
|
||
op0 = memory_address (mode, op0);
|
||
|
||
if (code == ALIGN_INDIRECT_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
int align = TYPE_ALIGN_UNIT (type);
|
||
op0 = gen_rtx_AND (Pmode, op0, GEN_INT (-align));
|
||
op0 = memory_address (mode, op0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
|
||
|
||
set_mem_attributes (temp, exp, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* Resolve the misalignment now, so that we don't have to remember
|
||
to resolve it later. Of course, this only works for reads. */
|
||
/* ??? When we get around to supporting writes, we'll have to handle
|
||
this in store_expr directly. The vectorizer isn't generating
|
||
those yet, however. */
|
||
if (code == MISALIGNED_INDIRECT_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
int icode;
|
||
rtx reg, insn;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (modifier == EXPAND_NORMAL
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM);
|
||
|
||
/* The vectorizer should have already checked the mode. */
|
||
icode = movmisalign_optab->handlers[mode].insn_code;
|
||
gcc_assert (icode != CODE_FOR_nothing);
|
||
|
||
/* We've already validated the memory, and we're creating a
|
||
new pseudo destination. The predicates really can't fail. */
|
||
reg = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
||
|
||
/* Nor can the insn generator. */
|
||
insn = GEN_FCN (icode) (reg, temp);
|
||
emit_insn (insn);
|
||
|
||
return reg;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return temp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case TARGET_MEM_REF:
|
||
{
|
||
struct mem_address addr;
|
||
|
||
get_address_description (exp, &addr);
|
||
op0 = addr_for_mem_ref (&addr, true);
|
||
op0 = memory_address (mode, op0);
|
||
temp = gen_rtx_MEM (mode, op0);
|
||
set_mem_attributes (temp, TMR_ORIGINAL (exp), 0);
|
||
}
|
||
return temp;
|
||
|
||
case ARRAY_REF:
|
||
|
||
{
|
||
tree array = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
tree index = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* Fold an expression like: "foo"[2].
|
||
This is not done in fold so it won't happen inside &.
|
||
Don't fold if this is for wide characters since it's too
|
||
difficult to do correctly and this is a very rare case. */
|
||
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY)
|
||
{
|
||
tree t = fold_read_from_constant_string (exp);
|
||
|
||
if (t)
|
||
return expand_expr (t, target, tmode, modifier);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a constant index into a constant array,
|
||
just get the value from the array. Handle both the cases when
|
||
we have an explicit constructor and when our operand is a variable
|
||
that was declared const. */
|
||
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (array) == CONSTRUCTOR
|
||
&& ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
|
||
tree field, value;
|
||
|
||
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (array), ix,
|
||
field, value)
|
||
if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
|
||
return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode, modifier);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (optimize >= 1
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_MEMORY
|
||
&& TREE_READONLY (array) && ! TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (array)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != ERROR_MARK
|
||
&& targetm.binds_local_p (array))
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (index) == INTEGER_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
tree init = DECL_INITIAL (array);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (init) == CONSTRUCTOR)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
|
||
tree field, value;
|
||
|
||
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init), ix,
|
||
field, value)
|
||
if (tree_int_cst_equal (field, index))
|
||
{
|
||
if (!TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (value))
|
||
return expand_expr (fold (value), target, tmode,
|
||
modifier);
|
||
break;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
else if(TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
tree index1 = index;
|
||
tree low_bound = array_ref_low_bound (exp);
|
||
index1 = fold_convert (sizetype, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
||
|
||
/* Optimize the special-case of a zero lower bound.
|
||
|
||
We convert the low_bound to sizetype to avoid some problems
|
||
with constant folding. (E.g. suppose the lower bound is 1,
|
||
and its mode is QI. Without the conversion,l (ARRAY
|
||
+(INDEX-(unsigned char)1)) becomes ((ARRAY+(-(unsigned char)1))
|
||
+INDEX), which becomes (ARRAY+255+INDEX). Opps!) */
|
||
|
||
if (! integer_zerop (low_bound))
|
||
index1 = size_diffop (index1, fold_convert (sizetype,
|
||
low_bound));
|
||
|
||
if (0 > compare_tree_int (index1,
|
||
TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)))
|
||
{
|
||
tree type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (init));
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1)
|
||
return gen_int_mode (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)
|
||
[TREE_INT_CST_LOW (index1)],
|
||
mode);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
goto normal_inner_ref;
|
||
|
||
case COMPONENT_REF:
|
||
/* If the operand is a CONSTRUCTOR, we can just extract the
|
||
appropriate field if it is present. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == CONSTRUCTOR)
|
||
{
|
||
unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT idx;
|
||
tree field, value;
|
||
|
||
FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_ELT (CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)),
|
||
idx, field, value)
|
||
if (field == TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)
|
||
/* We can normally use the value of the field in the
|
||
CONSTRUCTOR. However, if this is a bitfield in
|
||
an integral mode that we can fit in a HOST_WIDE_INT,
|
||
we must mask only the number of bits in the bitfield,
|
||
since this is done implicitly by the constructor. If
|
||
the bitfield does not meet either of those conditions,
|
||
we can't do this optimization. */
|
||
&& (! DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
|
||
|| ((GET_MODE_CLASS (DECL_MODE (field)) == MODE_INT)
|
||
&& (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (DECL_MODE (field))
|
||
<= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT))))
|
||
{
|
||
if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field)
|
||
&& modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (value, target, tmode, modifier);
|
||
if (DECL_BIT_FIELD (field))
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize = TREE_INT_CST_LOW (DECL_SIZE (field));
|
||
enum machine_mode imode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (field));
|
||
|
||
if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (field)))
|
||
{
|
||
op1 = GEN_INT (((HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << bitsize) - 1);
|
||
op0 = expand_and (imode, op0, op1, target);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
tree count
|
||
= build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
|
||
GET_MODE_BITSIZE (imode) - bitsize);
|
||
|
||
op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
|
||
target, 0);
|
||
op0 = expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, imode, op0, count,
|
||
target, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return op0;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
goto normal_inner_ref;
|
||
|
||
case BIT_FIELD_REF:
|
||
case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
|
||
normal_inner_ref:
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode1;
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos;
|
||
tree offset;
|
||
int volatilep = 0;
|
||
tree tem = get_inner_reference (exp, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset,
|
||
&mode1, &unsignedp, &volatilep, true);
|
||
rtx orig_op0;
|
||
|
||
/* If we got back the original object, something is wrong. Perhaps
|
||
we are evaluating an expression too early. In any event, don't
|
||
infinitely recurse. */
|
||
gcc_assert (tem != exp);
|
||
|
||
/* If TEM's type is a union of variable size, pass TARGET to the inner
|
||
computation, since it will need a temporary and TARGET is known
|
||
to have to do. This occurs in unchecked conversion in Ada. */
|
||
|
||
orig_op0 = op0
|
||
= expand_expr (tem,
|
||
(TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (tem)) == UNION_TYPE
|
||
&& (TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (tem)))
|
||
!= INTEGER_CST)
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
|
||
? target : NULL_RTX),
|
||
VOIDmode,
|
||
(modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
? modifier : EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a constant, put it into a register if it is a legitimate
|
||
constant, OFFSET is 0, and we won't try to extract outside the
|
||
register (in case we were passed a partially uninitialized object
|
||
or a view_conversion to a larger size). Force the constant to
|
||
memory otherwise. */
|
||
if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (tem));
|
||
if (mode != BLKmode && LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (op0)
|
||
&& offset == 0
|
||
&& bitpos + bitsize <= GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode))
|
||
op0 = force_reg (mode, op0);
|
||
else
|
||
op0 = validize_mem (force_const_mem (mode, op0));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise, if this object not in memory and we either have an
|
||
offset, a BLKmode result, or a reference outside the object, put it
|
||
there. Such cases can occur in Ada if we have unchecked conversion
|
||
of an expression from a scalar type to an array or record type or
|
||
for an ARRAY_RANGE_REF whose type is BLKmode. */
|
||
else if (!MEM_P (op0)
|
||
&& (offset != 0
|
||
|| (bitpos + bitsize > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
|
||
|| (code == ARRAY_RANGE_REF && mode == BLKmode)))
|
||
{
|
||
tree nt = build_qualified_type (TREE_TYPE (tem),
|
||
(TYPE_QUALS (TREE_TYPE (tem))
|
||
| TYPE_QUAL_CONST));
|
||
rtx memloc = assign_temp (nt, 1, 1, 1);
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (memloc, op0);
|
||
op0 = memloc;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (offset != 0)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx offset_rtx = expand_expr (offset, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode,
|
||
EXPAND_SUM);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0));
|
||
|
||
#ifdef POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
|
||
if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != Pmode)
|
||
offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (Pmode, offset_rtx, 0);
|
||
#else
|
||
if (GET_MODE (offset_rtx) != ptr_mode)
|
||
offset_rtx = convert_to_mode (ptr_mode, offset_rtx, 0);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode
|
||
/* A constant address in OP0 can have VOIDmode, we must
|
||
not try to call force_reg in that case. */
|
||
&& GET_MODE (XEXP (op0, 0)) != VOIDmode
|
||
&& bitsize != 0
|
||
&& (bitpos % bitsize) == 0
|
||
&& (bitsize % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)) == 0
|
||
&& MEM_ALIGN (op0) == GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1))
|
||
{
|
||
op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
bitpos = 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op0 = offset_address (op0, offset_rtx,
|
||
highest_pow2_factor (offset));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If OFFSET is making OP0 more aligned than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT,
|
||
record its alignment as BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (op0) && bitpos == 0 && offset != 0
|
||
&& is_aligning_offset (offset, tem))
|
||
set_mem_align (op0, BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT);
|
||
|
||
/* Don't forget about volatility even if this is a bitfield. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (op0) && volatilep && ! MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0))
|
||
{
|
||
if (op0 == orig_op0)
|
||
op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
|
||
|
||
MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) = 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* The following code doesn't handle CONCAT.
|
||
Assume only bitpos == 0 can be used for CONCAT, due to
|
||
one element arrays having the same mode as its element. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) == CONCAT)
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (bitpos == 0
|
||
&& bitsize == GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)));
|
||
return op0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* In cases where an aligned union has an unaligned object
|
||
as a field, we might be extracting a BLKmode value from
|
||
an integer-mode (e.g., SImode) object. Handle this case
|
||
by doing the extract into an object as wide as the field
|
||
(which we know to be the width of a basic mode), then
|
||
storing into memory, and changing the mode to BLKmode. */
|
||
if (mode1 == VOIDmode
|
||
|| REG_P (op0) || GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG
|
||
|| (mode1 != BLKmode && ! direct_load[(int) mode1]
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
&& modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
/* If the field isn't aligned enough to fetch as a memref,
|
||
fetch it as a bit field. */
|
||
|| (mode1 != BLKmode
|
||
&& (((TYPE_ALIGN (TREE_TYPE (tem)) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode)
|
||
|| (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode) != 0)
|
||
|| (MEM_P (op0)
|
||
&& (MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1)
|
||
|| (bitpos % GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (mode1) != 0))))
|
||
&& ((modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
? STRICT_ALIGNMENT
|
||
: SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (mode1, MEM_ALIGN (op0))))
|
||
|| (bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)))
|
||
/* If the type and the field are a constant size and the
|
||
size of the type isn't the same size as the bitfield,
|
||
we must use bitfield operations. */
|
||
|| (bitsize >= 0
|
||
&& TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp))) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& 0 != compare_tree_int (TYPE_SIZE (TREE_TYPE (exp)),
|
||
bitsize)))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode ext_mode = mode;
|
||
|
||
if (ext_mode == BLKmode
|
||
&& ! (target != 0 && MEM_P (op0)
|
||
&& MEM_P (target)
|
||
&& bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT == 0))
|
||
ext_mode = mode_for_size (bitsize, MODE_INT, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (ext_mode == BLKmode)
|
||
{
|
||
if (target == 0)
|
||
target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (bitsize == 0)
|
||
return target;
|
||
|
||
/* In this case, BITPOS must start at a byte boundary and
|
||
TARGET, if specified, must be a MEM. */
|
||
gcc_assert (MEM_P (op0)
|
||
&& (!target || MEM_P (target))
|
||
&& !(bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT));
|
||
|
||
emit_block_move (target,
|
||
adjust_address (op0, VOIDmode,
|
||
bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT),
|
||
GEN_INT ((bitsize + BITS_PER_UNIT - 1)
|
||
/ BITS_PER_UNIT),
|
||
(modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
|
||
? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
|
||
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op0 = validize_mem (op0);
|
||
|
||
if (MEM_P (op0) && REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
|
||
mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
|
||
|
||
op0 = extract_bit_field (op0, bitsize, bitpos, unsignedp,
|
||
(modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
|
||
? NULL_RTX : target),
|
||
ext_mode, ext_mode);
|
||
|
||
/* If the result is a record type and BITSIZE is narrower than
|
||
the mode of OP0, an integral mode, and this is a big endian
|
||
machine, we must put the field into the high-order bits. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (op0)) == MODE_INT
|
||
&& bitsize < (HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
|
||
op0 = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (op0), op0,
|
||
size_int (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (op0))
|
||
- bitsize),
|
||
op0, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* If the result type is BLKmode, store the data into a temporary
|
||
of the appropriate type, but with the mode corresponding to the
|
||
mode for the data we have (op0's mode). It's tempting to make
|
||
this a constant type, since we know it's only being stored once,
|
||
but that can cause problems if we are taking the address of this
|
||
COMPONENT_REF because the MEM of any reference via that address
|
||
will have flags corresponding to the type, which will not
|
||
necessarily be constant. */
|
||
if (mode == BLKmode)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx new
|
||
= assign_stack_temp_for_type
|
||
(ext_mode, GET_MODE_BITSIZE (ext_mode), 0, type);
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (new, op0);
|
||
op0 = copy_rtx (new);
|
||
PUT_MODE (op0, BLKmode);
|
||
set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return op0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the result is BLKmode, use that to access the object
|
||
now as well. */
|
||
if (mode == BLKmode)
|
||
mode1 = BLKmode;
|
||
|
||
/* Get a reference to just this component. */
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
op0 = adjust_address_nv (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
else
|
||
op0 = adjust_address (op0, mode1, bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT);
|
||
|
||
if (op0 == orig_op0)
|
||
op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
|
||
|
||
set_mem_attributes (op0, exp, 0);
|
||
if (REG_P (XEXP (op0, 0)))
|
||
mark_reg_pointer (XEXP (op0, 0), MEM_ALIGN (op0));
|
||
|
||
MEM_VOLATILE_P (op0) |= volatilep;
|
||
if (mode == mode1 || mode1 == BLKmode || mode1 == tmode
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_CONST_ADDRESS
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
return op0;
|
||
else if (target == 0)
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
|
||
|
||
convert_move (target, op0, unsignedp);
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case OBJ_TYPE_REF:
|
||
return expand_expr (OBJ_TYPE_REF_EXPR (exp), target, tmode, modifier);
|
||
|
||
case CALL_EXPR:
|
||
/* Check for a built-in function. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == ADDR_EXPR
|
||
&& (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
|
||
== FUNCTION_DECL)
|
||
&& DECL_BUILT_IN (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
|
||
{
|
||
if (DECL_BUILT_IN_CLASS (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))
|
||
== BUILT_IN_FRONTEND)
|
||
return lang_hooks.expand_expr (exp, original_target,
|
||
tmode, modifier,
|
||
alt_rtl);
|
||
else
|
||
return expand_builtin (exp, target, subtarget, tmode, ignore);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return expand_call (exp, target, ignore);
|
||
|
||
case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
|
||
case NOP_EXPR:
|
||
case CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
if (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) == error_mark_node)
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (type) == UNION_TYPE)
|
||
{
|
||
tree valtype = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
|
||
/* If both input and output are BLKmode, this conversion isn't doing
|
||
anything except possibly changing memory attribute. */
|
||
if (mode == BLKmode && TYPE_MODE (valtype) == BLKmode)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx result = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, tmode,
|
||
modifier);
|
||
|
||
result = copy_rtx (result);
|
||
set_mem_attributes (result, exp, 0);
|
||
return result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (target == 0)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode)
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (type));
|
||
else
|
||
target = assign_temp (type, 0, 1, 1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (MEM_P (target))
|
||
/* Store data into beginning of memory target. */
|
||
store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
|
||
adjust_address (target, TYPE_MODE (valtype), 0),
|
||
modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM);
|
||
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
gcc_assert (REG_P (target));
|
||
|
||
/* Store this field into a union of the proper type. */
|
||
store_field (target,
|
||
MIN ((int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE
|
||
(TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
|
||
* BITS_PER_UNIT),
|
||
(HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode)),
|
||
0, TYPE_MODE (valtype), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0),
|
||
type, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the entire union. */
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (mode == TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
|
||
{
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode,
|
||
modifier);
|
||
|
||
/* If the signedness of the conversion differs and OP0 is
|
||
a promoted SUBREG, clear that indication since we now
|
||
have to do the proper extension. */
|
||
if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) != unsignedp
|
||
&& GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
|
||
SUBREG_PROMOTED_VAR_P (op0) = 0;
|
||
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, mode,
|
||
modifier == EXPAND_SUM ? EXPAND_NORMAL : modifier);
|
||
if (GET_MODE (op0) == mode)
|
||
;
|
||
|
||
/* If OP0 is a constant, just convert it into the proper mode. */
|
||
else if (CONSTANT_P (op0))
|
||
{
|
||
tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
enum machine_mode inner_mode = TYPE_MODE (inner_type);
|
||
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
op0 = simplify_gen_subreg (mode, op0, inner_mode,
|
||
subreg_lowpart_offset (mode,
|
||
inner_mode));
|
||
else
|
||
op0= convert_modes (mode, inner_mode, op0,
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (inner_type));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
op0 = gen_rtx_fmt_e (unsignedp ? ZERO_EXTEND : SIGN_EXTEND, mode, op0);
|
||
|
||
else if (target == 0)
|
||
op0 = convert_to_mode (mode, op0,
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
|
||
(TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
convert_move (target, op0,
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
|
||
op0 = target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
|
||
|
||
case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), NULL_RTX, mode, modifier);
|
||
|
||
/* If the input and output modes are both the same, we are done. */
|
||
if (TYPE_MODE (type) == GET_MODE (op0))
|
||
;
|
||
/* If neither mode is BLKmode, and both modes are the same size
|
||
then we can use gen_lowpart. */
|
||
else if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode && GET_MODE (op0) != BLKmode
|
||
&& GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))
|
||
== GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (op0)))
|
||
{
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op0) == SUBREG)
|
||
op0 = force_reg (GET_MODE (op0), op0);
|
||
op0 = gen_lowpart (TYPE_MODE (type), op0);
|
||
}
|
||
/* If both modes are integral, then we can convert from one to the
|
||
other. */
|
||
else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (GET_MODE (op0))
|
||
&& SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
|
||
op0 = convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (type), GET_MODE (op0), op0,
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
|
||
/* As a last resort, spill op0 to memory, and reload it in a
|
||
different mode. */
|
||
else if (!MEM_P (op0))
|
||
{
|
||
/* If the operand is not a MEM, force it into memory. Since we
|
||
are going to be changing the mode of the MEM, don't call
|
||
force_const_mem for constants because we don't allow pool
|
||
constants to change mode. */
|
||
tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
|
||
|
||
if (target == 0 || GET_MODE (target) != TYPE_MODE (inner_type))
|
||
target
|
||
= assign_stack_temp_for_type
|
||
(TYPE_MODE (inner_type),
|
||
GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (inner_type)), 0, inner_type);
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, op0);
|
||
op0 = target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* At this point, OP0 is in the correct mode. If the output type is such
|
||
that the operand is known to be aligned, indicate that it is.
|
||
Otherwise, we need only be concerned about alignment for non-BLKmode
|
||
results. */
|
||
if (MEM_P (op0))
|
||
{
|
||
op0 = copy_rtx (op0);
|
||
|
||
if (TYPE_ALIGN_OK (type))
|
||
set_mem_align (op0, MAX (MEM_ALIGN (op0), TYPE_ALIGN (type)));
|
||
else if (TYPE_MODE (type) != BLKmode && STRICT_ALIGNMENT
|
||
&& MEM_ALIGN (op0) < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (TYPE_MODE (type)))
|
||
{
|
||
tree inner_type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT temp_size
|
||
= MAX (int_size_in_bytes (inner_type),
|
||
(HOST_WIDE_INT) GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type)));
|
||
rtx new = assign_stack_temp_for_type (TYPE_MODE (type),
|
||
temp_size, 0, type);
|
||
rtx new_with_op0_mode = adjust_address (new, GET_MODE (op0), 0);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (exp));
|
||
|
||
if (GET_MODE (op0) == BLKmode)
|
||
emit_block_move (new_with_op0_mode, op0,
|
||
GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (type))),
|
||
(modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
|
||
? BLOCK_OP_CALL_PARM : BLOCK_OP_NORMAL));
|
||
else
|
||
emit_move_insn (new_with_op0_mode, op0);
|
||
|
||
op0 = new;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op0 = adjust_address (op0, TYPE_MODE (type), 0);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return op0;
|
||
|
||
case PLUS_EXPR:
|
||
/* If we are adding a constant, a VAR_DECL that is sp, fp, or ap, and
|
||
something else, make sure we add the register to the constant and
|
||
then to the other thing. This case can occur during strength
|
||
reduction and doing it this way will produce better code if the
|
||
frame pointer or argument pointer is eliminated.
|
||
|
||
fold-const.c will ensure that the constant is always in the inner
|
||
PLUS_EXPR, so the only case we need to do anything about is if
|
||
sp, ap, or fp is our second argument, in which case we must swap
|
||
the innermost first argument and our second argument. */
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == PLUS_EXPR
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1)) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == VAR_DECL
|
||
&& (DECL_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == frame_pointer_rtx
|
||
|| DECL_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == stack_pointer_rtx
|
||
|| DECL_RTL (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == arg_pointer_rtx))
|
||
{
|
||
tree t = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0);
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0) = t;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If the result is to be ptr_mode and we are adding an integer to
|
||
something, we might be forming a constant. So try to use
|
||
plus_constant. If it produces a sum and we can't accept it,
|
||
use force_operand. This allows P = &ARR[const] to generate
|
||
efficient code on machines where a SYMBOL_REF is not a valid
|
||
address.
|
||
|
||
If this is an EXPAND_SUM call, always return the sum. */
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
|| (mode == ptr_mode && (unsignedp || ! flag_trapv)))
|
||
{
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& TREE_CONSTANT (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx constant_part;
|
||
|
||
op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), subtarget, VOIDmode,
|
||
EXPAND_SUM);
|
||
/* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
|
||
truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
|
||
to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
|
||
in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
|
||
constant_part
|
||
= immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)),
|
||
(HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
|
||
TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))));
|
||
op1 = plus_constant (op1, INTVAL (constant_part));
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
op1 = force_operand (op1, target);
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op1);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& GET_MODE_BITSIZE (mode) <= HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT
|
||
&& TREE_CONSTANT (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx constant_part;
|
||
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode,
|
||
(modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER
|
||
? EXPAND_INITIALIZER : EXPAND_SUM));
|
||
if (! CONSTANT_P (op0))
|
||
{
|
||
op1 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), NULL_RTX,
|
||
VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
/* Return a PLUS if modifier says it's OK. */
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
return simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1);
|
||
goto binop2;
|
||
}
|
||
/* Use immed_double_const to ensure that the constant is
|
||
truncated according to the mode of OP1, then sign extended
|
||
to a HOST_WIDE_INT. Using the constant directly can result
|
||
in non-canonical RTL in a 64x32 cross compile. */
|
||
constant_part
|
||
= immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
|
||
(HOST_WIDE_INT) 0,
|
||
TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
|
||
op0 = plus_constant (op0, INTVAL (constant_part));
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
op0 = force_operand (op0, target);
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (op0);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
|
||
if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
|
||
And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
|
||
zero-extend. */
|
||
if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
|| mode != ptr_mode)
|
||
{
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
|
||
if (op0 == const0_rtx)
|
||
return op1;
|
||
if (op1 == const0_rtx)
|
||
return op0;
|
||
goto binop2;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
|
||
|
||
case MINUS_EXPR:
|
||
/* For initializers, we are allowed to return a MINUS of two
|
||
symbolic constants. Here we handle all cases when both operands
|
||
are constant. */
|
||
/* Handle difference of two symbolic constants,
|
||
for the sake of an initializer. */
|
||
if ((modifier == EXPAND_SUM || modifier == EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
&& really_constant_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
|
||
&& really_constant_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)))
|
||
{
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, modifier);
|
||
|
||
/* If the last operand is a CONST_INT, use plus_constant of
|
||
the negated constant. Else make the MINUS. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (plus_constant (op0, - INTVAL (op1)));
|
||
else
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MINUS (mode, op0, op1));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* No sense saving up arithmetic to be done
|
||
if it's all in the wrong mode to form part of an address.
|
||
And force_operand won't know whether to sign-extend or
|
||
zero-extend. */
|
||
if ((modifier != EXPAND_SUM && modifier != EXPAND_INITIALIZER)
|
||
|| mode != ptr_mode)
|
||
goto binop;
|
||
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
subtarget, &op0, &op1, modifier);
|
||
|
||
/* Convert A - const to A + (-const). */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (op1) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
op1 = negate_rtx (mode, op1);
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (simplify_gen_binary (PLUS, mode, op0, op1));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
goto binop2;
|
||
|
||
case MULT_EXPR:
|
||
/* If first operand is constant, swap them.
|
||
Thus the following special case checks need only
|
||
check the second operand. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == INTEGER_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
tree t1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0) = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1) = t1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Attempt to return something suitable for generating an
|
||
indexed address, for machines that support that. */
|
||
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_SUM && mode == ptr_mode
|
||
&& host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0))
|
||
{
|
||
tree exp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode,
|
||
EXPAND_SUM);
|
||
|
||
if (!REG_P (op0))
|
||
op0 = force_operand (op0, NULL_RTX);
|
||
if (!REG_P (op0))
|
||
op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (mode, op0);
|
||
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (gen_rtx_MULT (mode, op0,
|
||
gen_int_mode (tree_low_cst (exp1, 0),
|
||
TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp1)))));
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Check for multiplying things that have been extended
|
||
from a narrower type. If this machine supports multiplying
|
||
in that narrower type with a result in the desired type,
|
||
do it that way, and avoid the explicit type-conversion. */
|
||
|
||
subexp0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
subexp1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
/* First, check if we have a multiplication of one signed and one
|
||
unsigned operand. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (subexp0) == NOP_EXPR
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (subexp1) == NOP_EXPR
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
|
||
&& (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (subexp0, 0)))
|
||
< TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
|
||
&& (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (subexp0, 0)))
|
||
== TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (subexp1, 0))))
|
||
&& (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (subexp0, 0)))
|
||
!= TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (subexp1, 0)))))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode innermode
|
||
= TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (subexp0, 0)));
|
||
this_optab = usmul_widen_optab;
|
||
if (mode == GET_MODE_WIDER_MODE (innermode))
|
||
{
|
||
if (this_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (subexp0, 0))))
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (subexp0, 0),
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (subexp1, 0),
|
||
NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, 0);
|
||
else
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (subexp0, 0),
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (subexp1, 0),
|
||
NULL_RTX, &op1, &op0, 0);
|
||
|
||
goto binop3;
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
/* Check for a multiplication with matching signedness. */
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)) == NOP_EXPR
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (type) == INTEGER_TYPE
|
||
&& (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
|
||
< TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
|
||
&& ((TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
|
||
&& int_fits_type_p (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))
|
||
/* Don't use a widening multiply if a shift will do. */
|
||
&& ((GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
|
||
> HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
|| exact_log2 (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) < 0))
|
||
||
|
||
(TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == NOP_EXPR
|
||
&& (TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE
|
||
(TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)))
|
||
== TYPE_PRECISION (TREE_TYPE
|
||
(TREE_OPERAND
|
||
(TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0))))
|
||
/* If both operands are extended, they must either both
|
||
be zero-extended or both be sign-extended. */
|
||
&& (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
|
||
(TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0)))
|
||
== TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE
|
||
(TREE_OPERAND
|
||
(TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0)))))))
|
||
{
|
||
tree op0type = TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0));
|
||
enum machine_mode innermode = TYPE_MODE (op0type);
|
||
bool zextend_p = TYPE_UNSIGNED (op0type);
|
||
optab other_optab = zextend_p ? smul_widen_optab : umul_widen_optab;
|
||
this_optab = zextend_p ? umul_widen_optab : smul_widen_optab;
|
||
|
||
if (mode == GET_MODE_2XWIDER_MODE (innermode))
|
||
{
|
||
if (this_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
else
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0),
|
||
TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0),
|
||
NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
goto binop3;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (other_optab->handlers[(int) mode].insn_code != CODE_FOR_nothing
|
||
&& innermode == word_mode)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx htem, hipart;
|
||
op0 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 0));
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) == INTEGER_CST)
|
||
op1 = convert_modes (innermode, mode,
|
||
expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)),
|
||
unsignedp);
|
||
else
|
||
op1 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 0));
|
||
temp = expand_binop (mode, other_optab, op0, op1, target,
|
||
unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
hipart = gen_highpart (innermode, temp);
|
||
htem = expand_mult_highpart_adjust (innermode, hipart,
|
||
op0, op1, hipart,
|
||
zextend_p);
|
||
if (htem != hipart)
|
||
emit_move_insn (hipart, htem);
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (expand_mult (mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp));
|
||
|
||
case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
|
||
case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
|
||
case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
|
||
case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
|
||
case EXACT_DIV_EXPR:
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
/* Possible optimization: compute the dividend with EXPAND_SUM
|
||
then if the divisor is constant can optimize the case
|
||
where some terms of the dividend have coeffs divisible by it. */
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
|
||
return expand_divmod (0, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
|
||
|
||
case RDIV_EXPR:
|
||
goto binop;
|
||
|
||
case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
|
||
case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
|
||
case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
|
||
case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
|
||
return expand_divmod (1, code, mode, op0, op1, target, unsignedp);
|
||
|
||
case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
|
||
case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
|
||
case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
|
||
gcc_unreachable (); /* Not used for C. */
|
||
|
||
case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
|
||
op0 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
||
expand_fix (target, op0, unsignedp);
|
||
return target;
|
||
|
||
case FLOAT_EXPR:
|
||
op0 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
if (target == 0 || modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
||
/* expand_float can't figure out what to do if FROM has VOIDmode.
|
||
So give it the correct mode. With -O, cse will optimize this. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE (op0) == VOIDmode)
|
||
op0 = copy_to_mode_reg (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))),
|
||
op0);
|
||
expand_float (target, op0,
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))));
|
||
return target;
|
||
|
||
case NEGATE_EXPR:
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
temp = expand_unop (mode,
|
||
optab_for_tree_code (NEGATE_EXPR, type),
|
||
op0, target, 0);
|
||
gcc_assert (temp);
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
|
||
|
||
case ABS_EXPR:
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
|
||
/* ABS_EXPR is not valid for complex arguments. */
|
||
gcc_assert (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_INT
|
||
&& GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) != MODE_COMPLEX_FLOAT);
|
||
|
||
/* Unsigned abs is simply the operand. Testing here means we don't
|
||
risk generating incorrect code below. */
|
||
if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
|
||
return op0;
|
||
|
||
return expand_abs (mode, op0, target, unsignedp,
|
||
safe_from_p (target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1));
|
||
|
||
case MAX_EXPR:
|
||
case MIN_EXPR:
|
||
target = original_target;
|
||
if (target == 0
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
|
||
|| (MEM_P (target) && MEM_VOLATILE_P (target))
|
||
|| GET_MODE (target) != mode
|
||
|| (REG_P (target)
|
||
&& REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER))
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
target, &op0, &op1, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* First try to do it with a special MIN or MAX instruction.
|
||
If that does not win, use a conditional jump to select the proper
|
||
value. */
|
||
this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type);
|
||
temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target, unsignedp,
|
||
OPTAB_WIDEN);
|
||
if (temp != 0)
|
||
return temp;
|
||
|
||
/* At this point, a MEM target is no longer useful; we will get better
|
||
code without it. */
|
||
|
||
if (! REG_P (target))
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
||
|
||
/* If op1 was placed in target, swap op0 and op1. */
|
||
if (target != op0 && target == op1)
|
||
{
|
||
temp = op0;
|
||
op0 = op1;
|
||
op1 = temp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* We generate better code and avoid problems with op1 mentioning
|
||
target by forcing op1 into a pseudo if it isn't a constant. */
|
||
if (! CONSTANT_P (op1))
|
||
op1 = force_reg (mode, op1);
|
||
|
||
{
|
||
enum rtx_code comparison_code;
|
||
rtx cmpop1 = op1;
|
||
|
||
if (code == MAX_EXPR)
|
||
comparison_code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
|
||
else
|
||
comparison_code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
|
||
|
||
/* Canonicalize to comparisons against 0. */
|
||
if (op1 == const1_rtx)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Converting (a >= 1 ? a : 1) into (a > 0 ? a : 1)
|
||
or (a != 0 ? a : 1) for unsigned.
|
||
For MIN we are safe converting (a <= 1 ? a : 1)
|
||
into (a <= 0 ? a : 1) */
|
||
cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
|
||
if (code == MAX_EXPR)
|
||
comparison_code = unsignedp ? NE : GT;
|
||
}
|
||
if (op1 == constm1_rtx && !unsignedp)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Converting (a >= -1 ? a : -1) into (a >= 0 ? a : -1)
|
||
and (a <= -1 ? a : -1) into (a < 0 ? a : -1) */
|
||
cmpop1 = const0_rtx;
|
||
if (code == MIN_EXPR)
|
||
comparison_code = LT;
|
||
}
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
|
||
/* Use a conditional move if possible. */
|
||
if (can_conditionally_move_p (mode))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx insn;
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Same problem as in expmed.c: emit_conditional_move
|
||
forces a stack adjustment via compare_from_rtx, and we
|
||
lose the stack adjustment if the sequence we are about
|
||
to create is discarded. */
|
||
do_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
||
|
||
start_sequence ();
|
||
|
||
/* Try to emit the conditional move. */
|
||
insn = emit_conditional_move (target, comparison_code,
|
||
op0, cmpop1, mode,
|
||
op0, op1, mode,
|
||
unsignedp);
|
||
|
||
/* If we could do the conditional move, emit the sequence,
|
||
and return. */
|
||
if (insn)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx seq = get_insns ();
|
||
end_sequence ();
|
||
emit_insn (seq);
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Otherwise discard the sequence and fall back to code with
|
||
branches. */
|
||
end_sequence ();
|
||
}
|
||
#endif
|
||
if (target != op0)
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, op0);
|
||
|
||
temp = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
do_compare_rtx_and_jump (target, cmpop1, comparison_code,
|
||
unsignedp, mode, NULL_RTX, NULL_RTX, temp);
|
||
}
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, op1);
|
||
emit_label (temp);
|
||
return target;
|
||
|
||
case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
temp = expand_unop (mode, one_cmpl_optab, op0, target, 1);
|
||
gcc_assert (temp);
|
||
return temp;
|
||
|
||
/* ??? Can optimize bitwise operations with one arg constant.
|
||
Can optimize (a bitwise1 n) bitwise2 (a bitwise3 b)
|
||
and (a bitwise1 b) bitwise2 b (etc)
|
||
but that is probably not worth while. */
|
||
|
||
/* BIT_AND_EXPR is for bitwise anding. TRUTH_AND_EXPR is for anding two
|
||
boolean values when we want in all cases to compute both of them. In
|
||
general it is fastest to do TRUTH_AND_EXPR by computing both operands
|
||
as actual zero-or-1 values and then bitwise anding. In cases where
|
||
there cannot be any side effects, better code would be made by
|
||
treating TRUTH_AND_EXPR like TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR; but the question is
|
||
how to recognize those cases. */
|
||
|
||
case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
|
||
code = BIT_AND_EXPR;
|
||
case BIT_AND_EXPR:
|
||
goto binop;
|
||
|
||
case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
|
||
code = BIT_IOR_EXPR;
|
||
case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
|
||
goto binop;
|
||
|
||
case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
|
||
code = BIT_XOR_EXPR;
|
||
case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
|
||
goto binop;
|
||
|
||
case LSHIFT_EXPR:
|
||
case RSHIFT_EXPR:
|
||
case LROTATE_EXPR:
|
||
case RROTATE_EXPR:
|
||
if (! safe_from_p (subtarget, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), 1))
|
||
subtarget = 0;
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), subtarget, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
return expand_shift (code, mode, op0, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), target,
|
||
unsignedp);
|
||
|
||
/* Could determine the answer when only additive constants differ. Also,
|
||
the addition of one can be handled by changing the condition. */
|
||
case LT_EXPR:
|
||
case LE_EXPR:
|
||
case GT_EXPR:
|
||
case GE_EXPR:
|
||
case EQ_EXPR:
|
||
case NE_EXPR:
|
||
case UNORDERED_EXPR:
|
||
case ORDERED_EXPR:
|
||
case UNLT_EXPR:
|
||
case UNLE_EXPR:
|
||
case UNGT_EXPR:
|
||
case UNGE_EXPR:
|
||
case UNEQ_EXPR:
|
||
case LTGT_EXPR:
|
||
temp = do_store_flag (exp,
|
||
modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM ? target : NULL_RTX,
|
||
tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode, 0);
|
||
if (temp != 0)
|
||
return temp;
|
||
|
||
/* For foo != 0, load foo, and if it is nonzero load 1 instead. */
|
||
if (code == NE_EXPR && integer_zerop (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))
|
||
&& original_target
|
||
&& REG_P (original_target)
|
||
&& (GET_MODE (original_target)
|
||
== TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0)))))
|
||
{
|
||
temp = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), original_target,
|
||
VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* If temp is constant, we can just compute the result. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (temp) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
if (INTVAL (temp) != 0)
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
|
||
else
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
|
||
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (temp != original_target)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode mode1 = GET_MODE (temp);
|
||
if (mode1 == VOIDmode)
|
||
mode1 = tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode;
|
||
|
||
temp = copy_to_mode_reg (mode1, temp);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (temp, const0_rtx, EQ, NULL_RTX,
|
||
GET_MODE (temp), unsignedp, op1);
|
||
emit_move_insn (temp, const1_rtx);
|
||
emit_label (op1);
|
||
return temp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If no set-flag instruction, must generate a conditional store
|
||
into a temporary variable. Drop through and handle this
|
||
like && and ||. */
|
||
|
||
if (! ignore
|
||
&& (target == 0
|
||
|| modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM
|
||
|| ! safe_from_p (target, exp, 1)
|
||
/* Make sure we don't have a hard reg (such as function's return
|
||
value) live across basic blocks, if not optimizing. */
|
||
|| (!optimize && REG_P (target)
|
||
&& REGNO (target) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)))
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (tmode != VOIDmode ? tmode : mode);
|
||
|
||
if (target)
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, const0_rtx);
|
||
|
||
op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
jumpifnot (exp, op1);
|
||
|
||
if (target)
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, const1_rtx);
|
||
|
||
emit_label (op1);
|
||
return ignore ? const0_rtx : target;
|
||
|
||
case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
op0 = expand_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), target, VOIDmode, 0);
|
||
/* The parser is careful to generate TRUTH_NOT_EXPR
|
||
only with operands that are always zero or one. */
|
||
temp = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, op0, const1_rtx,
|
||
target, 1, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
gcc_assert (temp);
|
||
return temp;
|
||
|
||
case STATEMENT_LIST:
|
||
{
|
||
tree_stmt_iterator iter;
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (ignore);
|
||
|
||
for (iter = tsi_start (exp); !tsi_end_p (iter); tsi_next (&iter))
|
||
expand_expr (tsi_stmt (iter), const0_rtx, VOIDmode, modifier);
|
||
}
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
case COND_EXPR:
|
||
/* A COND_EXPR with its type being VOID_TYPE represents a
|
||
conditional jump and is handled in
|
||
expand_gimple_cond_expr. */
|
||
gcc_assert (!VOID_TYPE_P (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
|
||
|
||
/* Note that COND_EXPRs whose type is a structure or union
|
||
are required to be constructed to contain assignments of
|
||
a temporary variable, so that we can evaluate them here
|
||
for side effect only. If type is void, we must do likewise. */
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (!TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)
|
||
&& !ignore
|
||
&& TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1)) != void_type_node
|
||
&& TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2)) != void_type_node);
|
||
|
||
/* If we are not to produce a result, we have no target. Otherwise,
|
||
if a target was specified use it; it will not be used as an
|
||
intermediate target unless it is safe. If no target, use a
|
||
temporary. */
|
||
|
||
if (modifier != EXPAND_STACK_PARM
|
||
&& original_target
|
||
&& safe_from_p (original_target, TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), 1)
|
||
&& GET_MODE (original_target) == mode
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_conditional_move
|
||
&& (! can_conditionally_move_p (mode)
|
||
|| REG_P (original_target))
|
||
#endif
|
||
&& !MEM_P (original_target))
|
||
temp = original_target;
|
||
else
|
||
temp = assign_temp (type, 0, 0, 1);
|
||
|
||
do_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
||
NO_DEFER_POP;
|
||
op0 = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
op1 = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
jumpifnot (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), op0);
|
||
store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1), temp,
|
||
modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM);
|
||
|
||
emit_jump_insn (gen_jump (op1));
|
||
emit_barrier ();
|
||
emit_label (op0);
|
||
store_expr (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2), temp,
|
||
modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM);
|
||
|
||
emit_label (op1);
|
||
OK_DEFER_POP;
|
||
return temp;
|
||
|
||
case VEC_COND_EXPR:
|
||
target = expand_vec_cond_expr (exp, target);
|
||
return target;
|
||
|
||
case MODIFY_EXPR:
|
||
{
|
||
tree lhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
tree rhs = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
|
||
gcc_assert (ignore);
|
||
|
||
/* Check for |= or &= of a bitfield of size one into another bitfield
|
||
of size 1. In this case, (unless we need the result of the
|
||
assignment) we can do this more efficiently with a
|
||
test followed by an assignment, if necessary.
|
||
|
||
??? At this point, we can't get a BIT_FIELD_REF here. But if
|
||
things change so we do, this code should be enhanced to
|
||
support it. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (lhs) == COMPONENT_REF
|
||
&& (TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_AND_EXPR)
|
||
&& TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 0) == lhs
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1)) == COMPONENT_REF
|
||
&& integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (lhs, 1)))
|
||
&& integer_onep (DECL_SIZE (TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1), 1))))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx label = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
int value = TREE_CODE (rhs) == BIT_IOR_EXPR;
|
||
do_jump (TREE_OPERAND (rhs, 1),
|
||
value ? label : 0,
|
||
value ? 0 : label);
|
||
expand_assignment (lhs, build_int_cst (TREE_TYPE (rhs), value));
|
||
do_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
||
emit_label (label);
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
expand_assignment (lhs, rhs);
|
||
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case RETURN_EXPR:
|
||
if (!TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))
|
||
expand_null_return ();
|
||
else
|
||
expand_return (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
case ADDR_EXPR:
|
||
return expand_expr_addr_expr (exp, target, tmode, modifier);
|
||
|
||
case COMPLEX_EXPR:
|
||
/* Get the rtx code of the operands. */
|
||
op0 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
op1 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1));
|
||
|
||
if (!target)
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp)));
|
||
|
||
/* Move the real (op0) and imaginary (op1) parts to their location. */
|
||
write_complex_part (target, op0, false);
|
||
write_complex_part (target, op1, true);
|
||
|
||
return target;
|
||
|
||
case REALPART_EXPR:
|
||
op0 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
return read_complex_part (op0, false);
|
||
|
||
case IMAGPART_EXPR:
|
||
op0 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
return read_complex_part (op0, true);
|
||
|
||
case RESX_EXPR:
|
||
expand_resx_expr (exp);
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
case TRY_CATCH_EXPR:
|
||
case CATCH_EXPR:
|
||
case EH_FILTER_EXPR:
|
||
case TRY_FINALLY_EXPR:
|
||
/* Lowered by tree-eh.c. */
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
|
||
case WITH_CLEANUP_EXPR:
|
||
case CLEANUP_POINT_EXPR:
|
||
case TARGET_EXPR:
|
||
case CASE_LABEL_EXPR:
|
||
case VA_ARG_EXPR:
|
||
case BIND_EXPR:
|
||
case INIT_EXPR:
|
||
case CONJ_EXPR:
|
||
case COMPOUND_EXPR:
|
||
case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
|
||
case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
|
||
case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
|
||
case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
|
||
case LOOP_EXPR:
|
||
case EXIT_EXPR:
|
||
case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
|
||
case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
|
||
/* Lowered by gimplify.c. */
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
|
||
case EXC_PTR_EXPR:
|
||
return get_exception_pointer (cfun);
|
||
|
||
case FILTER_EXPR:
|
||
return get_exception_filter (cfun);
|
||
|
||
case FDESC_EXPR:
|
||
/* Function descriptors are not valid except for as
|
||
initialization constants, and should not be expanded. */
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
|
||
case SWITCH_EXPR:
|
||
expand_case (exp);
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
case LABEL_EXPR:
|
||
expand_label (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
case ASM_EXPR:
|
||
expand_asm_expr (exp);
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
case WITH_SIZE_EXPR:
|
||
/* WITH_SIZE_EXPR expands to its first argument. The caller should
|
||
have pulled out the size to use in whatever context it needed. */
|
||
return expand_expr_real (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), original_target, tmode,
|
||
modifier, alt_rtl);
|
||
|
||
case REALIGN_LOAD_EXPR:
|
||
{
|
||
tree oprnd0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
tree oprnd1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
tree oprnd2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
|
||
rtx op2;
|
||
|
||
this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type);
|
||
expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
|
||
temp = expand_ternary_op (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, op2,
|
||
target, unsignedp);
|
||
gcc_assert (temp);
|
||
return temp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case DOT_PROD_EXPR:
|
||
{
|
||
tree oprnd0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
tree oprnd1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
tree oprnd2 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 2);
|
||
rtx op2;
|
||
|
||
expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
op2 = expand_normal (oprnd2);
|
||
target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (exp, op0, op1, op2,
|
||
target, unsignedp);
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case WIDEN_SUM_EXPR:
|
||
{
|
||
tree oprnd0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
tree oprnd1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
|
||
expand_operands (oprnd0, oprnd1, NULL_RTX, &op0, &op1, 0);
|
||
target = expand_widen_pattern_expr (exp, op0, NULL_RTX, op1,
|
||
target, unsignedp);
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case REDUC_MAX_EXPR:
|
||
case REDUC_MIN_EXPR:
|
||
case REDUC_PLUS_EXPR:
|
||
{
|
||
op0 = expand_normal (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0));
|
||
this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type);
|
||
temp = expand_unop (mode, this_optab, op0, target, unsignedp);
|
||
gcc_assert (temp);
|
||
return temp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
case VEC_LSHIFT_EXPR:
|
||
case VEC_RSHIFT_EXPR:
|
||
{
|
||
target = expand_vec_shift_expr (exp, target);
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
return lang_hooks.expand_expr (exp, original_target, tmode,
|
||
modifier, alt_rtl);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Here to do an ordinary binary operator. */
|
||
binop:
|
||
expand_operands (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0), TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1),
|
||
subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
|
||
binop2:
|
||
this_optab = optab_for_tree_code (code, type);
|
||
binop3:
|
||
if (modifier == EXPAND_STACK_PARM)
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
temp = expand_binop (mode, this_optab, op0, op1, target,
|
||
unsignedp, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
gcc_assert (temp);
|
||
return REDUCE_BIT_FIELD (temp);
|
||
}
|
||
#undef REDUCE_BIT_FIELD
|
||
|
||
/* Subroutine of above: reduce EXP to the precision of TYPE (in the
|
||
signedness of TYPE), possibly returning the result in TARGET. */
|
||
static rtx
|
||
reduce_to_bit_field_precision (rtx exp, rtx target, tree type)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT prec = TYPE_PRECISION (type);
|
||
if (target && GET_MODE (target) != GET_MODE (exp))
|
||
target = 0;
|
||
/* For constant values, reduce using build_int_cst_type. */
|
||
if (GET_CODE (exp) == CONST_INT)
|
||
{
|
||
HOST_WIDE_INT value = INTVAL (exp);
|
||
tree t = build_int_cst_type (type, value);
|
||
return expand_expr (t, target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
|
||
{
|
||
rtx mask;
|
||
if (prec < HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)
|
||
mask = immed_double_const (((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1 << prec) - 1, 0,
|
||
GET_MODE (exp));
|
||
else
|
||
mask = immed_double_const ((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) -1,
|
||
((unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) 1
|
||
<< (prec - HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT)) - 1,
|
||
GET_MODE (exp));
|
||
return expand_and (GET_MODE (exp), exp, mask, target);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
tree count = build_int_cst (NULL_TREE,
|
||
GET_MODE_BITSIZE (GET_MODE (exp)) - prec);
|
||
exp = expand_shift (LSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp), exp, count, target, 0);
|
||
return expand_shift (RSHIFT_EXPR, GET_MODE (exp), exp, count, target, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Subroutine of above: returns 1 if OFFSET corresponds to an offset that
|
||
when applied to the address of EXP produces an address known to be
|
||
aligned more than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
|
||
|
||
static int
|
||
is_aligning_offset (tree offset, tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
/* Strip off any conversions. */
|
||
while (TREE_CODE (offset) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (offset) == NOP_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (offset) == CONVERT_EXPR)
|
||
offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* We must now have a BIT_AND_EXPR with a constant that is one less than
|
||
power of 2 and which is larger than BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (offset) != BIT_AND_EXPR
|
||
|| !host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1)
|
||
|| compare_tree_int (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1),
|
||
BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT / BITS_PER_UNIT) <= 0
|
||
|| !exact_log2 (tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (offset, 1), 1) + 1) < 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Look at the first operand of BIT_AND_EXPR and strip any conversion.
|
||
It must be NEGATE_EXPR. Then strip any more conversions. */
|
||
offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
|
||
while (TREE_CODE (offset) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (offset) == NOP_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (offset) == CONVERT_EXPR)
|
||
offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (offset) != NEGATE_EXPR)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
|
||
while (TREE_CODE (offset) == NON_LVALUE_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (offset) == NOP_EXPR
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (offset) == CONVERT_EXPR)
|
||
offset = TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0);
|
||
|
||
/* This must now be the address of EXP. */
|
||
return TREE_CODE (offset) == ADDR_EXPR && TREE_OPERAND (offset, 0) == exp;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return the tree node if an ARG corresponds to a string constant or zero
|
||
if it doesn't. If we return nonzero, set *PTR_OFFSET to the offset
|
||
in bytes within the string that ARG is accessing. The type of the
|
||
offset will be `sizetype'. */
|
||
|
||
tree
|
||
string_constant (tree arg, tree *ptr_offset)
|
||
{
|
||
tree array, offset;
|
||
STRIP_NOPS (arg);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (arg) == ADDR_EXPR)
|
||
{
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == STRING_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
*ptr_offset = size_zero_node;
|
||
return TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == VAR_DECL)
|
||
{
|
||
array = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
|
||
offset = size_zero_node;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0)) == ARRAY_REF)
|
||
{
|
||
array = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 0);
|
||
offset = TREE_OPERAND (TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0), 1);
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (array) != STRING_CST
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (array) != VAR_DECL)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (arg) == PLUS_EXPR)
|
||
{
|
||
tree arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 0);
|
||
tree arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (arg, 1);
|
||
|
||
STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
|
||
STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == ADDR_EXPR
|
||
&& (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == STRING_CST
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
|
||
{
|
||
array = TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 0);
|
||
offset = arg1;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (arg1) == ADDR_EXPR
|
||
&& (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == STRING_CST
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0)) == VAR_DECL))
|
||
{
|
||
array = TREE_OPERAND (arg1, 0);
|
||
offset = arg0;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (array) == STRING_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
*ptr_offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
|
||
return array;
|
||
}
|
||
else if (TREE_CODE (array) == VAR_DECL)
|
||
{
|
||
int length;
|
||
|
||
/* Variables initialized to string literals can be handled too. */
|
||
if (DECL_INITIAL (array) == NULL_TREE
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (DECL_INITIAL (array)) != STRING_CST)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If they are read-only, non-volatile and bind locally. */
|
||
if (! TREE_READONLY (array)
|
||
|| TREE_SIDE_EFFECTS (array)
|
||
|| ! targetm.binds_local_p (array))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Avoid const char foo[4] = "abcde"; */
|
||
if (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array) == NULL_TREE
|
||
|| TREE_CODE (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array)) != INTEGER_CST
|
||
|| (length = TREE_STRING_LENGTH (DECL_INITIAL (array))) <= 0
|
||
|| compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) < 0)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* If variable is bigger than the string literal, OFFSET must be constant
|
||
and inside of the bounds of the string literal. */
|
||
offset = fold_convert (sizetype, offset);
|
||
if (compare_tree_int (DECL_SIZE_UNIT (array), length) > 0
|
||
&& (! host_integerp (offset, 1)
|
||
|| compare_tree_int (offset, length) >= 0))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
*ptr_offset = offset;
|
||
return DECL_INITIAL (array);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Generate code to calculate EXP using a store-flag instruction
|
||
and return an rtx for the result. EXP is either a comparison
|
||
or a TRUTH_NOT_EXPR whose operand is a comparison.
|
||
|
||
If TARGET is nonzero, store the result there if convenient.
|
||
|
||
If ONLY_CHEAP is nonzero, only do this if it is likely to be very
|
||
cheap.
|
||
|
||
Return zero if there is no suitable set-flag instruction
|
||
available on this machine.
|
||
|
||
Once expand_expr has been called on the arguments of the comparison,
|
||
we are committed to doing the store flag, since it is not safe to
|
||
re-evaluate the expression. We emit the store-flag insn by calling
|
||
emit_store_flag, but only expand the arguments if we have a reason
|
||
to believe that emit_store_flag will be successful. If we think that
|
||
it will, but it isn't, we have to simulate the store-flag with a
|
||
set/jump/set sequence. */
|
||
|
||
static rtx
|
||
do_store_flag (tree exp, rtx target, enum machine_mode mode, int only_cheap)
|
||
{
|
||
enum rtx_code code;
|
||
tree arg0, arg1, type;
|
||
tree tem;
|
||
enum machine_mode operand_mode;
|
||
int invert = 0;
|
||
int unsignedp;
|
||
rtx op0, op1;
|
||
enum insn_code icode;
|
||
rtx subtarget = target;
|
||
rtx result, label;
|
||
|
||
/* If this is a TRUTH_NOT_EXPR, set a flag indicating we must invert the
|
||
result at the end. We can't simply invert the test since it would
|
||
have already been inverted if it were valid. This case occurs for
|
||
some floating-point comparisons. */
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (exp) == TRUTH_NOT_EXPR)
|
||
invert = 1, exp = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
|
||
arg0 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0);
|
||
arg1 = TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* Don't crash if the comparison was erroneous. */
|
||
if (arg0 == error_mark_node || arg1 == error_mark_node)
|
||
return const0_rtx;
|
||
|
||
type = TREE_TYPE (arg0);
|
||
operand_mode = TYPE_MODE (type);
|
||
unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (type);
|
||
|
||
/* We won't bother with BLKmode store-flag operations because it would mean
|
||
passing a lot of information to emit_store_flag. */
|
||
if (operand_mode == BLKmode)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* We won't bother with store-flag operations involving function pointers
|
||
when function pointers must be canonicalized before comparisons. */
|
||
#ifdef HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
|
||
if (HAVE_canonicalize_funcptr_for_compare
|
||
&& ((TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))) == POINTER_TYPE
|
||
&& (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 0))))
|
||
== FUNCTION_TYPE))
|
||
|| (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))) == POINTER_TYPE
|
||
&& (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (exp, 1))))
|
||
== FUNCTION_TYPE))))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
STRIP_NOPS (arg0);
|
||
STRIP_NOPS (arg1);
|
||
|
||
/* Get the rtx comparison code to use. We know that EXP is a comparison
|
||
operation of some type. Some comparisons against 1 and -1 can be
|
||
converted to comparisons with zero. Do so here so that the tests
|
||
below will be aware that we have a comparison with zero. These
|
||
tests will not catch constants in the first operand, but constants
|
||
are rarely passed as the first operand. */
|
||
|
||
switch (TREE_CODE (exp))
|
||
{
|
||
case EQ_EXPR:
|
||
code = EQ;
|
||
break;
|
||
case NE_EXPR:
|
||
code = NE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case LT_EXPR:
|
||
if (integer_onep (arg1))
|
||
arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
|
||
else
|
||
code = unsignedp ? LTU : LT;
|
||
break;
|
||
case LE_EXPR:
|
||
if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
|
||
arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = LT;
|
||
else
|
||
code = unsignedp ? LEU : LE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case GT_EXPR:
|
||
if (! unsignedp && integer_all_onesp (arg1))
|
||
arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = GE;
|
||
else
|
||
code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
|
||
break;
|
||
case GE_EXPR:
|
||
if (integer_onep (arg1))
|
||
arg1 = integer_zero_node, code = unsignedp ? GTU : GT;
|
||
else
|
||
code = unsignedp ? GEU : GE;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
case UNORDERED_EXPR:
|
||
code = UNORDERED;
|
||
break;
|
||
case ORDERED_EXPR:
|
||
code = ORDERED;
|
||
break;
|
||
case UNLT_EXPR:
|
||
code = UNLT;
|
||
break;
|
||
case UNLE_EXPR:
|
||
code = UNLE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case UNGT_EXPR:
|
||
code = UNGT;
|
||
break;
|
||
case UNGE_EXPR:
|
||
code = UNGE;
|
||
break;
|
||
case UNEQ_EXPR:
|
||
code = UNEQ;
|
||
break;
|
||
case LTGT_EXPR:
|
||
code = LTGT;
|
||
break;
|
||
|
||
default:
|
||
gcc_unreachable ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Put a constant second. */
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (arg0) == REAL_CST || TREE_CODE (arg0) == INTEGER_CST)
|
||
{
|
||
tem = arg0; arg0 = arg1; arg1 = tem;
|
||
code = swap_condition (code);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this is an equality or inequality test of a single bit, we can
|
||
do this by shifting the bit being tested to the low-order bit and
|
||
masking the result with the constant 1. If the condition was EQ,
|
||
we xor it with 1. This does not require an scc insn and is faster
|
||
than an scc insn even if we have it.
|
||
|
||
The code to make this transformation was moved into fold_single_bit_test,
|
||
so we just call into the folder and expand its result. */
|
||
|
||
if ((code == NE || code == EQ)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (arg0) == BIT_AND_EXPR && integer_zerop (arg1)
|
||
&& integer_pow2p (TREE_OPERAND (arg0, 1)))
|
||
{
|
||
tree type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_mode (mode, unsignedp);
|
||
return expand_expr (fold_single_bit_test (code == NE ? NE_EXPR : EQ_EXPR,
|
||
arg0, arg1, type),
|
||
target, VOIDmode, EXPAND_NORMAL);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Now see if we are likely to be able to do this. Return if not. */
|
||
if (! can_compare_p (code, operand_mode, ccp_store_flag))
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
icode = setcc_gen_code[(int) code];
|
||
if (icode == CODE_FOR_nothing
|
||
|| (only_cheap && insn_data[(int) icode].operand[0].mode != mode))
|
||
{
|
||
/* We can only do this if it is one of the special cases that
|
||
can be handled without an scc insn. */
|
||
if ((code == LT && integer_zerop (arg1))
|
||
|| (! only_cheap && code == GE && integer_zerop (arg1)))
|
||
;
|
||
else if (! only_cheap && (code == NE || code == EQ)
|
||
&& TREE_CODE (type) != REAL_TYPE
|
||
&& ((abs_optab->handlers[(int) operand_mode].insn_code
|
||
!= CODE_FOR_nothing)
|
||
|| (ffs_optab->handlers[(int) operand_mode].insn_code
|
||
!= CODE_FOR_nothing)))
|
||
;
|
||
else
|
||
return 0;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
if (! get_subtarget (target)
|
||
|| GET_MODE (subtarget) != operand_mode)
|
||
subtarget = 0;
|
||
|
||
expand_operands (arg0, arg1, subtarget, &op0, &op1, 0);
|
||
|
||
if (target == 0)
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (mode);
|
||
|
||
result = emit_store_flag (target, code, op0, op1,
|
||
operand_mode, unsignedp, 1);
|
||
|
||
if (result)
|
||
{
|
||
if (invert)
|
||
result = expand_binop (mode, xor_optab, result, const1_rtx,
|
||
result, 0, OPTAB_LIB_WIDEN);
|
||
return result;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* If this failed, we have to do this with set/compare/jump/set code. */
|
||
if (!REG_P (target)
|
||
|| reg_mentioned_p (target, op0) || reg_mentioned_p (target, op1))
|
||
target = gen_reg_rtx (GET_MODE (target));
|
||
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, invert ? const0_rtx : const1_rtx);
|
||
result = compare_from_rtx (op0, op1, code, unsignedp,
|
||
operand_mode, NULL_RTX);
|
||
if (GET_CODE (result) == CONST_INT)
|
||
return (((result == const0_rtx && ! invert)
|
||
|| (result != const0_rtx && invert))
|
||
? const0_rtx : const1_rtx);
|
||
|
||
/* The code of RESULT may not match CODE if compare_from_rtx
|
||
decided to swap its operands and reverse the original code.
|
||
|
||
We know that compare_from_rtx returns either a CONST_INT or
|
||
a new comparison code, so it is safe to just extract the
|
||
code from RESULT. */
|
||
code = GET_CODE (result);
|
||
|
||
label = gen_label_rtx ();
|
||
gcc_assert (bcc_gen_fctn[(int) code]);
|
||
|
||
emit_jump_insn ((*bcc_gen_fctn[(int) code]) (label));
|
||
emit_move_insn (target, invert ? const1_rtx : const0_rtx);
|
||
emit_label (label);
|
||
|
||
return target;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
|
||
/* Stubs in case we haven't got a casesi insn. */
|
||
#ifndef HAVE_casesi
|
||
# define HAVE_casesi 0
|
||
# define gen_casesi(a, b, c, d, e) (0)
|
||
# define CODE_FOR_casesi CODE_FOR_nothing
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* If the machine does not have a case insn that compares the bounds,
|
||
this means extra overhead for dispatch tables, which raises the
|
||
threshold for using them. */
|
||
#ifndef CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD
|
||
#define CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (HAVE_casesi ? 4 : 5)
|
||
#endif /* CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD */
|
||
|
||
unsigned int
|
||
case_values_threshold (void)
|
||
{
|
||
return CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Attempt to generate a casesi instruction. Returns 1 if successful,
|
||
0 otherwise (i.e. if there is no casesi instruction). */
|
||
int
|
||
try_casesi (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
|
||
rtx table_label ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, rtx default_label)
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode index_mode = SImode;
|
||
int index_bits = GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode);
|
||
rtx op1, op2, index;
|
||
enum machine_mode op_mode;
|
||
|
||
if (! HAVE_casesi)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Convert the index to SImode. */
|
||
if (GET_MODE_BITSIZE (TYPE_MODE (index_type)) > GET_MODE_BITSIZE (index_mode))
|
||
{
|
||
enum machine_mode omode = TYPE_MODE (index_type);
|
||
rtx rangertx = expand_normal (range);
|
||
|
||
/* We must handle the endpoints in the original mode. */
|
||
index_expr = build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
|
||
index_expr, minval);
|
||
minval = integer_zero_node;
|
||
index = expand_normal (index_expr);
|
||
emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (rangertx, index, LTU, NULL_RTX,
|
||
omode, 1, default_label);
|
||
/* Now we can safely truncate. */
|
||
index = convert_to_mode (index_mode, index, 0);
|
||
}
|
||
else
|
||
{
|
||
if (TYPE_MODE (index_type) != index_mode)
|
||
{
|
||
index_type = lang_hooks.types.type_for_size (index_bits, 0);
|
||
index_expr = fold_convert (index_type, index_expr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
index = expand_normal (index_expr);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
do_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
||
|
||
op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[0].mode;
|
||
if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[0].predicate)
|
||
(index, op_mode))
|
||
index = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, index);
|
||
|
||
op1 = expand_normal (minval);
|
||
|
||
op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[1].mode;
|
||
op1 = convert_modes (op_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (minval)),
|
||
op1, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (minval)));
|
||
if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[1].predicate)
|
||
(op1, op_mode))
|
||
op1 = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, op1);
|
||
|
||
op2 = expand_normal (range);
|
||
|
||
op_mode = insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[2].mode;
|
||
op2 = convert_modes (op_mode, TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
|
||
op2, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range)));
|
||
if (! (*insn_data[(int) CODE_FOR_casesi].operand[2].predicate)
|
||
(op2, op_mode))
|
||
op2 = copy_to_mode_reg (op_mode, op2);
|
||
|
||
emit_jump_insn (gen_casesi (index, op1, op2,
|
||
table_label, default_label));
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Attempt to generate a tablejump instruction; same concept. */
|
||
#ifndef HAVE_tablejump
|
||
#define HAVE_tablejump 0
|
||
#define gen_tablejump(x, y) (0)
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* Subroutine of the next function.
|
||
|
||
INDEX is the value being switched on, with the lowest value
|
||
in the table already subtracted.
|
||
MODE is its expected mode (needed if INDEX is constant).
|
||
RANGE is the length of the jump table.
|
||
TABLE_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx for the table itself.
|
||
|
||
DEFAULT_LABEL is a CODE_LABEL rtx to jump to if the
|
||
index value is out of range. */
|
||
|
||
static void
|
||
do_tablejump (rtx index, enum machine_mode mode, rtx range, rtx table_label,
|
||
rtx default_label)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx temp, vector;
|
||
|
||
if (INTVAL (range) > cfun->max_jumptable_ents)
|
||
cfun->max_jumptable_ents = INTVAL (range);
|
||
|
||
/* Do an unsigned comparison (in the proper mode) between the index
|
||
expression and the value which represents the length of the range.
|
||
Since we just finished subtracting the lower bound of the range
|
||
from the index expression, this comparison allows us to simultaneously
|
||
check that the original index expression value is both greater than
|
||
or equal to the minimum value of the range and less than or equal to
|
||
the maximum value of the range. */
|
||
|
||
emit_cmp_and_jump_insns (index, range, GTU, NULL_RTX, mode, 1,
|
||
default_label);
|
||
|
||
/* If index is in range, it must fit in Pmode.
|
||
Convert to Pmode so we can index with it. */
|
||
if (mode != Pmode)
|
||
index = convert_to_mode (Pmode, index, 1);
|
||
|
||
/* Don't let a MEM slip through, because then INDEX that comes
|
||
out of PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS won't be a valid address,
|
||
and break_out_memory_refs will go to work on it and mess it up. */
|
||
#ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
|
||
if (flag_pic && !REG_P (index))
|
||
index = copy_to_mode_reg (Pmode, index);
|
||
#endif
|
||
|
||
/* If flag_force_addr were to affect this address
|
||
it could interfere with the tricky assumptions made
|
||
about addresses that contain label-refs,
|
||
which may be valid only very near the tablejump itself. */
|
||
/* ??? The only correct use of CASE_VECTOR_MODE is the one inside the
|
||
GET_MODE_SIZE, because this indicates how large insns are. The other
|
||
uses should all be Pmode, because they are addresses. This code
|
||
could fail if addresses and insns are not the same size. */
|
||
index = gen_rtx_PLUS (Pmode,
|
||
gen_rtx_MULT (Pmode, index,
|
||
GEN_INT (GET_MODE_SIZE (CASE_VECTOR_MODE))),
|
||
gen_rtx_LABEL_REF (Pmode, table_label));
|
||
#ifdef PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS
|
||
if (flag_pic)
|
||
index = PIC_CASE_VECTOR_ADDRESS (index);
|
||
else
|
||
#endif
|
||
index = memory_address_noforce (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
|
||
temp = gen_reg_rtx (CASE_VECTOR_MODE);
|
||
vector = gen_const_mem (CASE_VECTOR_MODE, index);
|
||
convert_move (temp, vector, 0);
|
||
|
||
emit_jump_insn (gen_tablejump (temp, table_label));
|
||
|
||
/* If we are generating PIC code or if the table is PC-relative, the
|
||
table and JUMP_INSN must be adjacent, so don't output a BARRIER. */
|
||
if (! CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE && ! flag_pic)
|
||
emit_barrier ();
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
try_tablejump (tree index_type, tree index_expr, tree minval, tree range,
|
||
rtx table_label, rtx default_label)
|
||
{
|
||
rtx index;
|
||
|
||
if (! HAVE_tablejump)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
index_expr = fold_build2 (MINUS_EXPR, index_type,
|
||
fold_convert (index_type, index_expr),
|
||
fold_convert (index_type, minval));
|
||
index = expand_normal (index_expr);
|
||
do_pending_stack_adjust ();
|
||
|
||
do_tablejump (index, TYPE_MODE (index_type),
|
||
convert_modes (TYPE_MODE (index_type),
|
||
TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (range)),
|
||
expand_normal (range),
|
||
TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (range))),
|
||
table_label, default_label);
|
||
return 1;
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Nonzero if the mode is a valid vector mode for this architecture.
|
||
This returns nonzero even if there is no hardware support for the
|
||
vector mode, but we can emulate with narrower modes. */
|
||
|
||
int
|
||
vector_mode_valid_p (enum machine_mode mode)
|
||
{
|
||
enum mode_class class = GET_MODE_CLASS (mode);
|
||
enum machine_mode innermode;
|
||
|
||
/* Doh! What's going on? */
|
||
if (class != MODE_VECTOR_INT
|
||
&& class != MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT)
|
||
return 0;
|
||
|
||
/* Hardware support. Woo hoo! */
|
||
if (targetm.vector_mode_supported_p (mode))
|
||
return 1;
|
||
|
||
innermode = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
|
||
|
||
/* We should probably return 1 if requesting V4DI and we have no DI,
|
||
but we have V2DI, but this is probably very unlikely. */
|
||
|
||
/* If we have support for the inner mode, we can safely emulate it.
|
||
We may not have V2DI, but me can emulate with a pair of DIs. */
|
||
return targetm.scalar_mode_supported_p (innermode);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Return a CONST_VECTOR rtx for a VECTOR_CST tree. */
|
||
static rtx
|
||
const_vector_from_tree (tree exp)
|
||
{
|
||
rtvec v;
|
||
int units, i;
|
||
tree link, elt;
|
||
enum machine_mode inner, mode;
|
||
|
||
mode = TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (exp));
|
||
|
||
if (initializer_zerop (exp))
|
||
return CONST0_RTX (mode);
|
||
|
||
units = GET_MODE_NUNITS (mode);
|
||
inner = GET_MODE_INNER (mode);
|
||
|
||
v = rtvec_alloc (units);
|
||
|
||
link = TREE_VECTOR_CST_ELTS (exp);
|
||
for (i = 0; link; link = TREE_CHAIN (link), ++i)
|
||
{
|
||
elt = TREE_VALUE (link);
|
||
|
||
if (TREE_CODE (elt) == REAL_CST)
|
||
RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST_DOUBLE_FROM_REAL_VALUE (TREE_REAL_CST (elt),
|
||
inner);
|
||
else
|
||
RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = immed_double_const (TREE_INT_CST_LOW (elt),
|
||
TREE_INT_CST_HIGH (elt),
|
||
inner);
|
||
}
|
||
|
||
/* Initialize remaining elements to 0. */
|
||
for (; i < units; ++i)
|
||
RTVEC_ELT (v, i) = CONST0_RTX (inner);
|
||
|
||
return gen_rtx_CONST_VECTOR (mode, v);
|
||
}
|
||
#include "gt-expr.h"
|